blob: 2e834fb7c2a687d8689abaa38f9b4b68c0ebeba8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau910d5ac2019-12-21 12:45:18 +01007 2019/12/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
852 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003354 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3514 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3515 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3516 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 Examples :
3519 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3520 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3521 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003522 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003524 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003525
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003526
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003527declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3528 Declares a capture slot.
3529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3530 no | yes | yes | no
3531 Arguments:
3532 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3533
3534 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3535 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3536 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3537 for use in the response.
3538
3539 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003540 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003541 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3542
3543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003544default-server [param*]
3545 Change default options for a server in a backend
3546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3547 yes | no | yes | yes
3548 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003549 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3550 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3551 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3552 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003553
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003555 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3556
3557 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003560default_backend <backend>
3561 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | yes | yes | no
3564 Arguments :
3565 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3566
3567 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3568 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3569 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3570 will catch all undetermined requests.
3571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572 Example :
3573
3574 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3575 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3576 default_backend dynamic
3577
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003578 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003581description <string>
3582 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 no | yes | yes | yes
3585 Arguments : string
3586
3587 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3588 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3589 it describes.
3590 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3591
3592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003593disabled
3594 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3596 yes | yes | yes | yes
3597 Arguments : none
3598
3599 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3600 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3601 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3602 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3603 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3604 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3605 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3606
3607 See also : "enabled"
3608
3609
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003610dispatch <address>:<port>
3611 Set a default server address
3612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3613 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003614 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615
3616 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3617 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3618 during start-up.
3619
3620 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3621 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3622 possible with normal servers.
3623
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003624 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003625 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3626 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3627 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3628 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3629
3630 See also : "server"
3631
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003632
3633dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3634 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3636 yes | no | yes | yes
3637 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3638
3639 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003640 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003641 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3642 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003643 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003644 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003645
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646enabled
3647 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | yes
3650 Arguments : none
3651
3652 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3653 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3654
3655 See also : "disabled"
3656
3657
3658errorfile <code> <file>
3659 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3661 yes | yes | yes | yes
3662 Arguments :
3663 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003664 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3665 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666
3667 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003668 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003670 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3671 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003672
3673 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3674 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3675 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3676
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003677 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3680 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3681 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3682 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3683
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003684 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3685 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003686 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003687 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3688 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3689 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003691 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3692 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3693 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003694 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3696
3697 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3698
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003699 Example :
3700 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003701 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003702 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3703 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3704
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705
3706errorloc <code> <url>
3707errorloc302 <code> <url>
3708 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | yes
3711 Arguments :
3712 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003713 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3714 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003715
3716 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3717 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3718 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3719 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003720 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003721
3722 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3723 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3724 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3725
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003726 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3727
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003728 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3729 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3730 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3731 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003732 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3734 request.
3735
3736 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3737
3738
3739errorloc303 <code> <url>
3740 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743 Arguments :
3744 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003745 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3746 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003747
3748 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3749 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3750 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3751 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003752 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003753
3754 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3755 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3756 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3757
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003758 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003760 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3761 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3762 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3763 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003764 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765
3766 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3767
3768
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003769email-alert from <emailaddr>
3770 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003771 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3773 yes | yes | yes | yes
3774
3775 Arguments :
3776
3777 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3778
3779 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3780 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3781
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003782 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003783 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3784 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003785
3786
3787email-alert level <level>
3788 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3789 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3791 yes | yes | yes | yes
3792
3793 Arguments :
3794
3795 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3796 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3797 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3798
3799 By default level is alert
3800
3801 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3802 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3803 for the proxy.
3804
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003805 Alerts are sent when :
3806
3807 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3808 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3809 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3810 is notice or lower
3811 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3812 and a health check status update occurs
3813
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003814 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3815 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003816 section 3.6 about mailers.
3817
3818
3819email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3820 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3822 yes | yes | yes | yes
3823
3824 Arguments :
3825
3826 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3827
3828 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3829 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3830
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003831 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3832 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003833
3834
3835email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3836 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3837 mailers.
3838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840
3841 Arguments :
3842
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003843 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003844
3845 By default the systems hostname is used.
3846
3847 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3848 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3849 for the proxy.
3850
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003851 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3852 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003853
3854
3855email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003856 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3859 yes | yes | yes | yes
3860
3861 Arguments :
3862
3863 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3864
3865 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3866 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3867
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003868 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003869 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3870
3871
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003872force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3873 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003875 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876
3877 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3878 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3879 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3880 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3881 marked down for maintenance operations.
3882
3883 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3884 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3885 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3886 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3887 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3888 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3889 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3890 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3891 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3892
3893 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3894 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3895 is used.
3896
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003897 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003898 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003899
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003900
3901filter <name> [param*]
3902 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 no | yes | yes | yes
3905 Arguments :
3906 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3907 referenced in section 9.
3908
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003909 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003910 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003911 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3912 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003913
3914 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3915 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3916
3917 Example:
3918 listen
3919 bind *:80
3920
3921 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3922 filter compression
3923 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3924
3925 compression algo gzip
3926 compression offload
3927
3928 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3929
3930 See also : section 9.
3931
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003933fullconn <conns>
3934 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | no | yes | yes
3937 Arguments :
3938 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3939 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3940
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003941 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003942 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003943 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003944 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3945 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3946 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3947 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3948 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003951 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3952 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003953 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3954 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3955 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003957 Example :
3958 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3959 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3960 # connections.
3961 backend dynamic
3962 fullconn 10000
3963 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3964 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3965
3966 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3967
3968
3969grace <time>
3970 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003972 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003973 Arguments :
3974 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3975 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3976 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3977
3978 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3979 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003980 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003981 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3982
3983 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3984 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3985 simplify it.
3986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003988hash-balance-factor <factor>
3989 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3991 yes | no | no | yes
3992 Arguments :
3993 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3994 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003995 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003996
3997 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3998 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3999 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4000 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4001 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4002 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4003 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4004
4005 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4006 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4007 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4008 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4009 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4010
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004011 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4012 consistent hashing mechanism.
4013
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004014 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4015
4016
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004017hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004018 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 yes | no | yes | yes
4021 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004022 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4023 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004024
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004025 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4026 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4027 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4028 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4029 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4030 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4031 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4032 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4033 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4034 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004035
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004036 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4037 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4038 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4039 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4040 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4041 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4042 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4043 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4044 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4045 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4046 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4047 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4048 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004049 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4050 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004051
4052 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004054 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004055 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4056 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4057 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004058 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4059 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4060 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004061
4062 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4063 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004064 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4065 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4066 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4067 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4068
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004069 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4070 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4071 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4072 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4073 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4074 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4075 parameter.
4076
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004077 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4078 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4079 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4080 used on strings.
4081
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004082 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4083
4084 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4085 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4086 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4087 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4088 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4089 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4090 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4091 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4092 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4093 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4094 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4095 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004096
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004097 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4098 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4099 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004100
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004101 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004102
4103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104http-check disable-on-404
4105 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004107 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108 Arguments : none
4109
4110 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4111 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4112 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4113 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4114 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4115 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4116 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4117 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4119 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4120 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4121
4122 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4123
4124
4125http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004126 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004128 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004129 Arguments :
4130 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4131 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004132 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004133 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4134 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4135 details on the supported keywords.
4136
4137 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4138 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4139 with the usual backslash ('\').
4140
4141 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4142 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4143 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4144 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4145 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4146
4147 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004148 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004149 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4150 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4151 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4152
4153 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004154 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004155 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4156 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4157 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4158 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4159
4160 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004161 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004162 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4163 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4164 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4165 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4166 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004167 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004168 trace).
4169
4170 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004171 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4173 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4174 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4175 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4176 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004177 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004178
4179 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4180 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4181 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4182 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4183 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4184 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4185 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4186 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4187
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004188 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4189 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4190 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4191
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004192 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4193 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4194
4195 Examples :
4196 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004197 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004198
4199 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004200 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004201
4202 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004203 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004204
4205 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004206 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004207
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004209
4210
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004211http-check send-state
4212 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 yes | no | yes | yes
4215 Arguments : none
4216
4217 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4218 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4219 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4220 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4221 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4222
4223 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4224 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4225 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4226 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4227 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004228 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4229 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4230 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4231
4232 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4233 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4234 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4235
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004236 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4237 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4238 checked in multiple backends.
4239
4240 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4241 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4242
4243 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4244 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4245 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4246 one fails.
4247
4248 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4249 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4250 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4251
4252 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4253 server's queue.
4254
4255 Example of a header received by the application server :
4256 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4257 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4258
4259 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261
4262http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004263 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4264
4265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 no | yes | yes | yes
4267
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004268 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4269 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4270 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4271 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4272 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4275 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4280 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4281 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4282 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4285 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4286 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4287 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 Example:
4290 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4291 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4292 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 http-request allow if nagios
4295 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4296 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4297 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 Example:
4300 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4301 acl add path /addacl
4302 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4307 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 Example:
4310 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4311 acl setmap path /setmap
4312 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4317 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4320 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4325 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4326 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4327 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4328 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4329 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4330 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4331 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004333http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4336 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4337 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4338 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4339 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4340 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4341 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4342 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4347 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4353 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4354 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4355 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4356 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 Example:
4359 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4360 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004361
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004362http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4367 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4370 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4371 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4372 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4373 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4374 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4375 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4376 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4377 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004379 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4380 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4381 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4382 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4383 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4384 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4389 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4390 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4391 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4392 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4393 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004401 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4402 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4403 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4404 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4405 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4406 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4411 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4412 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4413 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4414 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004415
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004416http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4417 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4418 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4419 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4420
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004421http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4422
4423 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4424 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4425 pointed by <resolvers>.
4426 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4427 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4428 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4429 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4430 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4431 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4432 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4433 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4434 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4435 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4436 to 0.0.0.0.
4437
4438 Example:
4439 resolvers mydns
4440 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4441 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4442 timeout retry 1s
4443 hold valid 10s
4444 hold nx 3s
4445 hold other 3s
4446 hold obsolete 0s
4447 accepted_payload_size 8192
4448
4449 frontend fe
4450 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4451 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4452 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4453
4454 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4455 # which mean DNS resolution error
4456 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4457
4458 default_backend be
4459
4460 backend b_503
4461 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4462 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4463 # 503 error page to end users
4464
4465 backend be
4466 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4467 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4468 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4469 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4470 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4471
4472 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4473 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4474
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004475http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4476
4477 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4478 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4479 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4480 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004481 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4482 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004483
4484 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004486http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4489 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4490 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4491 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4492 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4497 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4498 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4499 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004503
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004504 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4505 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4506 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4507 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4508 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4509 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004510
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004511 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4512 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4513 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4514 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4515 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004516
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004517 Example:
4518 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4519
4520 # applied to:
4521 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4522
4523 # outputs:
4524 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4525
4526 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004527
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004528 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4529
4530 # applied to:
4531 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004532
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004533 # outputs:
4534 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004535
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004536http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4537 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4538
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4540 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4541 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4542 against.
4543
4544 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4545 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4546 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004547
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004548 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4549 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4550 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4551 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4552 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4553 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4554 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4555 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4556 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
4557 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004558
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004559 Example:
4560 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4561 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004562
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004563 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4564 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004566http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4567 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004568
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004569 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4570 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4571 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4572 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004573
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004574 Example:
4575 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004576
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004577 # applied to:
4578 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004579
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004580 # outputs:
4581 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004583http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4584http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4587 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4588 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4593 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4594 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4599 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4600 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4601 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4602 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604 Arguments:
4605 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4606 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 Example:
4609 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4610 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4613 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4618 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4619 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 Arguments:
4622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4623 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 Example:
4626 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4627 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4630 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4631 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004633http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4636 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4637 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4638 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4639 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 Example:
4642 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4643 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4644 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4646 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4647 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4648 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4649 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4650 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4655 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4656 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4657 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4658 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4661 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4664 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4665 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4666 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4667 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4668 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4669 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4670 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4671 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4676 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4677 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4678 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4679 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4680 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4681 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004683http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4686 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4687 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4692 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4693 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4694 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4695 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4696 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4697 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4698 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4703 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4704 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4705 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4706 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4707 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709 Example :
4710 # prepend the host name before the path
4711 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004713http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004715 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4716 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4717 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4718 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4719 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4724 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4725 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4726 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4727 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4728 values have higher priority.
4729 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4730 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4731 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4732 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4733 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004737 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4738 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4739 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4740 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4741 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4742 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4743 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004745 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004746
4747 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4749 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004751http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4752 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4753 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4754 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4755 privacy.
4756
4757 Arguments :
4758 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4759 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004760
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4763 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4764
4765 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4766 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4767
4768http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769
4770 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4771 expression.
4772
4773 Arguments:
4774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4775 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004776
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004777 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4779 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4780
4781 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4782 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4783 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4784
4785http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4786
4787 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4788 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4789 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4790 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4791 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4792 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4793 information from the request.
4794
4795 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4796
4797http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4798
4799 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4800 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4801 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4802 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4803 path and the query string.
4804 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4805
4806http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4807
4808 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4809 inline.
4810
4811 Arguments:
4812 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4813 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4817 (request and response)
4818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4819 processing
4820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4821 processing
4822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4823 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4824 and '_'.
4825
4826 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4827 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004828
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004829 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004830 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004832http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4833 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004835 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4836 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4837 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4838 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4839 agent name must be used.
4840
4841 Arguments:
4842 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4843
4844 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4845 configuration.
4846
4847http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4848
4849 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4850 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4851 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4852 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4853 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4854 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4855 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4856 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4857 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4858 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4859 action.
4860 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4861 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4862 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4863 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4864 you fully understand how it works.
4865
4866http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4867
4868 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4869 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4870 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4871 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4872 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4873 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4874 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4875 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4876 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4877 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4878 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4879 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4880 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4881
4882http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4883http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4884http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4885
4886 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4887 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4888 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4889 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4890 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4891 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4892 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4893 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4894 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4895 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4896 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4897 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4901 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4902 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4903 select which table entry to update the counters.
4904
4905 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4906 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4907 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4908 that table until the session ends.
4909
4910 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4911 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4912 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4913 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4914 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4915 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4916 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4917 useful information.
4918
4919 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4920 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4921 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4922 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4923 checks that make use of it.
4924
4925http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4926
4927 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004928
4929 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004930 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004931
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004932http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4933
4934 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4935 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4936 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4937 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4938 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4939 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4940
4941 Arguments :
4942 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4943
4944 Example:
4945 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004947http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004949 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4950 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4951 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004952
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004955 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4956
4957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 no | yes | yes | yes
4959
4960 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4961 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4962 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4963 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4964 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4965 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4968 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4973 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4974 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4975 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4978 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4979 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4980 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 Example:
4983 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4988 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 Example:
4991 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004995 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4996 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4999 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5004 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5005 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5006 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5007 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5008 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5009 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5010 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005014 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5015 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5016 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5017 example, or to pass some internal information.
5018 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5019 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5020 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5025 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005026
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005027http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5034 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5035 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5036 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5037 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5038 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5039 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5042 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5043 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5044 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5045 keyword.
5046 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5047 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5052 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5053 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5054 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5055 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5056 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005058http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5065 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5066 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5067 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5068 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5069 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5074 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5079 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5080 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5081 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5082 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5083 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005087
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005088 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5089 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005091 Example:
5092 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005094 # applied to:
5095 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097 # outputs:
5098 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5103 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005104
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005105 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5106 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005108 Example:
5109 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005111 # applied to:
5112 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005114 # outputs:
5115 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005117http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5118http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5121 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5122 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005124http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5127 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5128 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005130http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005132 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5133 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5134 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5135 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5136 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005138 Arguments:
5139 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5142 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005144http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5147 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5148 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005150http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5151
5152 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5153 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5154 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5155 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5156 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5157
5158http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5159
5160 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5161 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5162 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5163 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5164 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5165 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5166 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5167 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5168 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5169
5170http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5171
5172 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5173 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5174 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5175 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5176 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5177 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5178 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5179
5180http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5181
5182 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5183 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5184 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5185 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5186 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5187 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5188 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5189 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5190
5191http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5192 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5193
5194 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5195 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5196 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5197 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005198
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005199 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005200 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5201 http-response set-status 431
5202 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5203 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005207 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5208 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5209 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5210 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5211 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5212 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5213 based on some information from the request.
5214
5215 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5216
5217http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5218
5219 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5220 inline.
5221
5222 Arguments:
5223 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5224 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5228 (request and response)
5229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5230 processing
5231 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5232 processing
5233 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5234 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5235 and '_'.
5236
5237 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5238 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005239
5240 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005241 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005243http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005245 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5246 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5247 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5248 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5249 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5250 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5251 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5252 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5253 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5254 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5255 action.
5256 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5257 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5258 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5259 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5260 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005262http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5263http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5264http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005266 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5267 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5268 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5269 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5270 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5271 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5272
5273http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5274
5275 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5276 about <var-name>.
5277
5278 Example:
5279 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5280
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005281
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005282http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5283 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5284
5285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | no | yes | yes
5287
5288 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005289 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5290 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5291 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005292
5293 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5294
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005295 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5296 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5297 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5298 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5299 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5300 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5301 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5302 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5303 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5304 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005305
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005306 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5307 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5308 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5309 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5310 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5311 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5312 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5313 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005314
5315 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5316 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5317 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5318 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5319 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5320 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5321 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5322 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005323 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005324 downsides of rare connection failures.
5325
5326 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5327 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5328 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5329 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5330 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5331 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005332 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005333 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5334 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5335 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5336 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5337 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5338
5339 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005340 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5341 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5342 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005343
5344 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005345 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005346
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005347 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5348 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005349
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005350 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005351
5352 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5353 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5354 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5355
5356 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5357
5358
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005359http-send-name-header [<header>]
5360 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005363 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005364 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5365
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005366 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5367 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5368 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5369 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5370 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5371 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5372 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5373 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5374 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5375 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5376 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5377 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5378 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5379 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5380 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5381 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005382
5383 See also : "server"
5384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005385id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005386 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 no | yes | yes | yes
5389 Arguments : none
5390
5391 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5392 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5393 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005394
5395
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005396ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5397 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005399 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005400
5401 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5402 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5403 and running).
5404
5405 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5406 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5407 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005408 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005409 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5410
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005411 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5412 "unless" condition is met.
5413
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005414 Example:
5415 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5416 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5417 ignore-persist if url_static
5418
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005419 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5420
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005421load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5422 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5424 yes | no | yes | yes
5425
5426 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5427 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5428 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005429 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005430 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5431 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5432 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5433 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5434
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005435 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005436 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005437 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005438
5439 Arguments:
5440 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5441 named "server-state-file".
5442
5443 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5444 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5445 name is used as a file name.
5446
5447 none don't load any stat for this backend
5448
5449 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005450 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5451 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5452 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005453 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005454 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005455
5456 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5457 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5458
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005459 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005460
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005461 global
5462 stats socket /tmp/socket
5463 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005464
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005465 defaults
5466 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005467
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005468 backend bk
5469 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5470 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005471
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005472
5473 Then one can run :
5474
5475 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5476
5477 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5478
5479 1
5480 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5481 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5482 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5483
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005484 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005485
5486 global
5487 stats socket /tmp/socket
5488 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5489
5490 defaults
5491 load-server-state-from-file local
5492
5493 backend bk
5494 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5495 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5496
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005497
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005498 Then one can run :
5499
5500 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5501
5502 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5503
5504 1
5505 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5506 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5507 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5508
5509 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5510 "show servers state"
5511
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005514log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5515 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005516no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005517 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005520
5521 Prefix :
5522 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5523 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5524 prefix does not allow arguments.
5525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005526 Arguments :
5527 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5528 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5529 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5530 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5531 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5532 parameter.
5533
5534 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5535 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5536
5537 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5538 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5539 standard syslog port).
5540
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005541 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5542 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5543 standard syslog port).
5544
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005545 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5546 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5547 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005548 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005549
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005550 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5551 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5552 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5553 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5554 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5555 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5556 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5557 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5558 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5559 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5560 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5561 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5562 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5563 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5564 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5565 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005566 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5567 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005568
5569 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5570 and "fd@2", see above.
5571
5572 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5573 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005574
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005575 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5576 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5577 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5578 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5579 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5580 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5581 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5582 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5583 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5584 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005585 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005586
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005587 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5588 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5589 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5590 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5591 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5592
5593 <sample_size>
5594 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5595 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5596 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5597 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5598 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5599
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005600 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5601 one of the following :
5602
5603 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5604 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5605
5606 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5607 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5608
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005609 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5610 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5611 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5612 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5613 systemd logger consumes.
5614
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005615 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5616 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5617 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5618 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5619
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005620 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5621
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005622 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5623 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5624 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5625
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005626 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5627 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5628 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5629 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630
5631 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5632 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5633 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005634 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5635 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5636 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5637 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5638 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005639
5640 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5641
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005642 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5643 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5644 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005645
5646 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5647 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5648 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5649 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5650
5651 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5652 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005653
5654 Example :
5655 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005656 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5657 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5658 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005659 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5660 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005661 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005663
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005664log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005665 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005668
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005669 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5670 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5671 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5672 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5673 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005674
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005675 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5676 "option httplog" directives.
5677
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005678log-format-sd <string>
5679 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5681 yes | yes | yes | no
5682
5683 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5684 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5685 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5686 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5687 which covers the log format string in depth.
5688
5689 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5690 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5691
5692 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5693 log format to "rfc5424".
5694
5695 Example :
5696 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5697
5698
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005699log-tag <string>
5700 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 yes | yes | yes | yes
5703
5704 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5705 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5706 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5707 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5708 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5709 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5710 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5711 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5712 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005713
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005714max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5715 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 yes | no | yes | yes
5718
5719 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5720 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5721 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5722 servers.
5723
5724 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5725 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5726 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5727 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5728 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005729 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005730 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5731 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5732 picking a different server.
5733
5734 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5735 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5736 even if they have to be queued.
5737
5738 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5739 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5740
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005741max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5742 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5743 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5744 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005746maxconn <conns>
5747 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5749 yes | yes | yes | no
5750 Arguments :
5751 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5752 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5753 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5754 closes.
5755
5756 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5757 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5758 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5759 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005760 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5761 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5762 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5763 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005764
5765 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5766 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5767 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5768
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005769 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5770 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005771
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005772 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5773
5774
5775mode { tcp|http|health }
5776 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 yes | yes | yes | yes
5779 Arguments :
5780 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5781 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5782 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5783 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5784
5785 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5786 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5787 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5788 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5789 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5790
5791 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005792 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5793 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5794 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5795 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5796 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5797 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5798 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005800 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5801 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5802 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005803
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005804 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005805 defaults http_instances
5806 mode http
5807
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005808 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005810
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005811monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005812 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005815 Arguments :
5816 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5817 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005818 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005819 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5820 backend and its backup.
5821
5822 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5823 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5824 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5825 servers in a list of backends.
5826
5827 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5828 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5829 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5830 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5831 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5832 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5833 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005834 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5835 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005836
5837 Example:
5838 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005839 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005840 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5841 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5842 monitor-uri /site_alive
5843 monitor fail if site_dead
5844
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005845 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005846
5847
5848monitor-net <source>
5849 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | yes | yes | no
5852 Arguments :
5853 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5854 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5855 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5856 followed by a mask.
5857
5858 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5859 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005860 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005861 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5862
5863 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5864 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5865 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5866 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005867 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5868 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5869 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005870
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005871 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5872 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5873 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5874 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5875 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5876 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005877
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005878 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5879 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005881 Example :
5882 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5883 frontend www
5884 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5885
5886 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5887
5888
5889monitor-uri <uri>
5890 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | yes | yes | no
5893 Arguments :
5894 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5895 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5896
5897 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5898 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5899 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5900 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5901 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5902 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5903 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5904 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5905
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005906 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5907 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5908 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5909 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5910 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5911 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5912 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5913 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005914
5915 Example :
5916 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5917 frontend www
5918 mode http
5919 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5920
5921 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005923
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005924option abortonclose
5925no option abortonclose
5926 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 yes | no | yes | yes
5929 Arguments : none
5930
5931 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5932 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5933 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5934 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005935 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005936 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5937 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5938 encountered while delivering the response.
5939
5940 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5941 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5942 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5943 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5944 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5945 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005946 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005947 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005948 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005949 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5950 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5951 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5952
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005953 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5954 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005955 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5956 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5957 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5958 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5959 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5960 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005961 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005962
5963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5965
5966 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5967
5968
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005969option accept-invalid-http-request
5970no option accept-invalid-http-request
5971 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 yes | yes | yes | no
5974 Arguments : none
5975
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005976 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005977 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005978 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005979 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5980 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5981 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5982 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5983 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005984 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5985 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5986 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5987 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005988 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005989 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005990 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5991 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5992 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005993
5994 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5995 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5996 been confirmed.
5997
5998 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5999 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006000 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6001 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006002 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6003
6004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6006
6007 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6008 stats socket.
6009
6010
6011option accept-invalid-http-response
6012no option accept-invalid-http-response
6013 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | no | yes | yes
6016 Arguments : none
6017
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006018 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006019 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006020 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006021 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6022 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6023 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6024 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6025 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006026 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6027 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6028 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006029
6030 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6031 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6032 been confirmed.
6033
6034 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6035 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6036 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6037 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6038
6039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6041
6042 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6043 stats socket.
6044
6045
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006046option allbackups
6047no option allbackups
6048 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6050 yes | no | yes | yes
6051 Arguments : none
6052
6053 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6054 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6055 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6056 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6057 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6058 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6059 order between the backup servers anymore.
6060
6061 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6062 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6063
6064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6066
6067
6068option checkcache
6069no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006070 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6072 yes | no | yes | yes
6073 Arguments : none
6074
6075 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6076 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006077 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006078 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6079 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006080 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006081
6082 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006083 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006084 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006085 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6086 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006087 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006088 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006089 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6090 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006091 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006092 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6093 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006094 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006095 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6096 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6097 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6098 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6099 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6100 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6101 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6102 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6103 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6104
6105 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006106 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006107 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006108 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006109 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6110
6111 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6112 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006113 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006114 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006115
6116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6118
6119
6120option clitcpka
6121no option clitcpka
6122 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6124 yes | yes | yes | no
6125 Arguments : none
6126
6127 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6128 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006129 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006130 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6131
6132 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6133 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6134 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6135 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6136
6137 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6138 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6139 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6140 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6141 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6142
6143 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6144
6145 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6146 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6147 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6148
6149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6151
6152 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6153
6154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006155option contstats
6156 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6158 yes | yes | yes | no
6159 Arguments : none
6160
6161 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6162 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6163 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6164 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006165 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6166 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6167 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6168 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6169 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006170
6171
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006172option dontlog-normal
6173no option dontlog-normal
6174 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | yes | yes | no
6177 Arguments : none
6178
6179 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6180 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6181 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6182 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6183 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6184 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6185 logged.
6186
6187 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6188 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6189 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006191 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006192 logging.
6193
6194
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006195option dontlognull
6196no option dontlognull
6197 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | yes | yes | no
6200 Arguments : none
6201
6202 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6203 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6204 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6205 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6206 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6207 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006208 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6209 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6210 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006211
6212 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006213 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006214 would not be logged.
6215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006219 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6220 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006221
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006222
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006223option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006224 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | yes | yes | yes
6227 Arguments :
6228 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6229 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006230 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006231 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006232
6233 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6234 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6235 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6236 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6237 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6238 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6239 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006240 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6241 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6242 possible that the client has already brought one.
6243
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006244 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006245 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006246 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006247 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006248 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006249 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006250
6251 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6252 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6253 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6254 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6255 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6256 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6257 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6258
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006259 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6260 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6261 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6262 are under the control of the end-user.
6263
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006264 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006265 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6266 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006267 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6268 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6269 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006270
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006271 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006272 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6273 frontend www
6274 mode http
6275 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6276
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006277 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6278 backend www
6279 mode http
6280 option forwardfor header X-Client
6281
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006282 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006283 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006284
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006285
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006286option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6287no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6288 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | yes | yes | no
6291 Arguments : none
6292
6293 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6294 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6295 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6296 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6297 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6298 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6299 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6300
6301 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6302 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6303 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6304 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6305 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6306 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6307 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6308 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6309 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6310 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6311
6312 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6313
6314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6316
6317 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6318 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6319
6320
6321option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6322no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6323 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | no | yes | yes
6326 Arguments : none
6327
6328 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6329 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6330 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6331 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6332 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6333 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6334 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6335
6336 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6337 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6338 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6339 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6340 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6341 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6342 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6343 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6344 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6345 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6346
6347 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6348
6349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6351
6352 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6353 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6354
6355
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006356option http-buffer-request
6357no option http-buffer-request
6358 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | yes
6361 Arguments : none
6362
6363 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6364 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6365 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6366 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6367 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6368 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6369 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6370 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006371 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006372 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6373 default.
6374
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006375 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006376
6377
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006378option http-ignore-probes
6379no option http-ignore-probes
6380 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6382 yes | yes | yes | no
6383 Arguments : none
6384
6385 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6386 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6387 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6388 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6389 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6390 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6391 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6392 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6393 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6395 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006396 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6397
6398 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6399 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6400 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6401 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6402 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6403 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6404 are often the only way to detect them.
6405
6406 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6407 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6408
6409 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6410
6411
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006412option http-keep-alive
6413no option http-keep-alive
6414 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 yes | yes | yes | yes
6417 Arguments : none
6418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6420 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006421 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6422 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6423 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6424 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6425 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006426
6427 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6428 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006429 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6430 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6431 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6432 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6433 situations where this option may be useful :
6434
6435 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006436 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006437
6438 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6439 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6440
6441 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6442 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6443 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6444 request.
6445
6446 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6447 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006448 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6449 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6450 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006451
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006452 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6453 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6454 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6455 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6456 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6457 not set.
6458
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006459 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006460 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6461 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006462
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006463 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006464 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006465 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006466
6467
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006468option http-no-delay
6469no option http-no-delay
6470 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6472 yes | yes | yes | yes
6473 Arguments : none
6474
6475 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6476 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6477 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6478 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6479 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6480 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6481 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6482 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6483 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6484 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6485 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6486 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6487 affected.
6488
6489 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6490 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6491 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6492 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6493 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6494 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6495 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6496 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6497 latency environments.
6498
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006499 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6500
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006501
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006502option http-pretend-keepalive
6503no option http-pretend-keepalive
6504 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006506 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006507 Arguments : none
6508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006509 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006510 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6511 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6512 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6513 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6514 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6515 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6516 consider the response complete.
6517
6518 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6519 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6520 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6521 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006522 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006523 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6524
6525 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6526 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6527 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6528 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6529 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6530 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6531 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6532
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006533 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6534 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6535 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6536 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6537 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6538 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006539
6540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6542
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006543 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006544 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006545
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006546
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006547option http-server-close
6548no option http-server-close
6549 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | yes
6552 Arguments : none
6553
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006554 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6555 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6556 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6557 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006558 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6559 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6560 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6561 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6562 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6563 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6564 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6565 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6566 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6567 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6568 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006569
6570 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6571 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6572 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6573 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006574 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6575 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006576
6577 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6578 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6580 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6581 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006582
6583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006586 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6587 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006588
6589
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006590option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6591no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6592 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006594 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006595 Arguments : none
6596
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006597 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6598 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6599 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6600
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006601 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6602 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6603 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6604 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006605 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006606
6607 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006608 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006609 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6610 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6611 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6612 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6613 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6614 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6615 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006616
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006617 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6618 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6619 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6620 backend.
6621
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6624
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006625 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6626 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006627
6628
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006629option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006630no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006631 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | yes | yes | no
6634 Arguments : none
6635
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006636 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006637 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6638 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6639 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6640 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6641 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6642 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6643
6644 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6645 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006646 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6647 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6648 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006649
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006650 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6651 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6652 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6653 front of an existing proxy.
6654
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006655 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6656
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006657 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006658
6659
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006660option http-use-htx
6661no option http-use-htx
6662 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | yes | yes | yes
6665 Arguments : none
6666
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006667 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006668 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006669 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6670 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6671 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6672 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6673 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006674
6675 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6676 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6677 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6678 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006679 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6680 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6681 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6682 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006683
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006684 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6685 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6686 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6687 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6688 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006689
6690 See also : "mode http"
6691
6692
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006693option httpchk
6694option httpchk <uri>
6695option httpchk <method> <uri>
6696option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6697 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6699 yes | no | yes | yes
6700 Arguments :
6701 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6702 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6703 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6704 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6705 ones.
6706
6707 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6708 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6709 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6710
6711 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6712 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6713 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6714 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6715 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6716
6717 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6718 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6719 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6720 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6721 the lack of any response.
6722
6723 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6724
6725 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6726 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6727 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6728
6729 Examples :
6730 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6731 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6732 backend https_relay
6733 mode tcp
6734 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6735 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6736
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006737 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6738 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6739 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006740
6741
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006742option httpclose
6743no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006744 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | yes | yes | yes
6747 Arguments : none
6748
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006749 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6750 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6751 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6752 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006753 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006754
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006755 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6756 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006757 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006758 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6759 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006760
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006761 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6762 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6763 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006764
6765 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6766 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006767 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006768 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6769 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6770 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771
6772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006775 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006776
6777
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006778option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006779 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006781 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006782 Arguments :
6783 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6784 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6785 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006786 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006787 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006788
6789 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6790 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6791 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6792 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6793 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6794 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6795 ports.
6796
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006797 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6798 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006799
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006800 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006802 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006803
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006804
6805option http_proxy
6806no option http_proxy
6807 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | yes | yes | yes
6810 Arguments : none
6811
6812 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6813 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6814 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6815 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6816 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6817
6818 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6819 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006820 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6821 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006822
6823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6825
6826 Example :
6827 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6828 backend direct_forward
6829 option httpclose
6830 option http_proxy
6831
6832 See also : "option httpclose"
6833
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006834
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006835option independent-streams
6836no option independent-streams
6837 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 yes | yes | yes | yes
6840 Arguments : none
6841
6842 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6843 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6844 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6845 receive data or not.
6846
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006847 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006848 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6849 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6850 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6851 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6852 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6853 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6854 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6855 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6856 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6857 socket buffers.
6858
6859 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6860 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6861 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6862 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6863 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6864
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006865 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006866 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6867 deprecated.
6868
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006869 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006870
6871
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006872option ldap-check
6873 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | no | yes | yes
6876 Arguments : none
6877
6878 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6879 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6880 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6881 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6882
6883 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6884 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6885
6886 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6887 configure it.
6888
6889 Example :
6890 option ldap-check
6891
6892 See also : "option httpchk"
6893
6894
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006895option external-check
6896 Use external processes for server health checks
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | no | yes | yes
6899
6900 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6901 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6902 command".
6903
6904 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6905
6906 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6907
6908
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006909option log-health-checks
6910no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006911 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6913 yes | no | yes | yes
6914 Arguments : none
6915
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006916 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6917 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6918 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006919
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006920 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6921 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6922 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6923 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6924 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6925
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006926 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006927 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006928
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006929 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6930 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6931 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006932
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006933
6934option log-separate-errors
6935no option log-separate-errors
6936 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 yes | yes | yes | no
6939 Arguments : none
6940
6941 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6942 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6943 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6944 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6945 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6946 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6947 provides very important information.
6948
6949 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6950 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6951 error logs.
6952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006954 logging.
6955
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006956
6957option logasap
6958no option logasap
6959 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 yes | yes | yes | no
6962 Arguments : none
6963
6964 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6965 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6966 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6967 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6968 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6969 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6970 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006971 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006972 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6973 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006975 Examples :
6976 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6977 mode http
6978 option httplog
6979 option logasap
6980 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6981
6982 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6983 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6984 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6985 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006987 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006988 logging.
6989
6990
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006991option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006992 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006995 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006996 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6997 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006998 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006999
7000 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7001 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007003 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7004 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7005 in the MySQL table, like this :
7006
7007 USE mysql;
7008 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7009 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7010
7011 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007012 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007013 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7014 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7015 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7016 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7017 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7018 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7019 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7020
7021 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7022 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007023
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007024 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007025
7026 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7027 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7028 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7029 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007030 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7031 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007032
7033 See also: "option httpchk"
7034
7035
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007036option nolinger
7037no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007038 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007039 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7040 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007041 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007042
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007043 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007044 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7045 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7046 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7047 connections.
7048
7049 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7050 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7051 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7052 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7053 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7054 this too.
7055
7056 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7057 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7058 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7059
7060 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7061 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7062 for servers.
7063
7064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7066
7067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007068option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7069 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 yes | yes | yes | yes
7072 Arguments :
7073 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7074 matching <network>
7075 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7076 header name.
7077
7078 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7079 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7080 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7081 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7082 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7083 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7084 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7085 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7086 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7087 possible that the client has already brought one.
7088
7089 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7090 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7091 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7092 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7093 header and requires different one.
7094
7095 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7096 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7097 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7098 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7099 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7100 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7101 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7102
7103 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7104 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7105 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7106 both are defined.
7107
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007108 Examples :
7109 # Original Destination address
7110 frontend www
7111 mode http
7112 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7113
7114 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7115 backend www
7116 mode http
7117 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7118
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007119 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007120
7121
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007122option persist
7123no option persist
7124 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007127 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007128
7129 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7130 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7131 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7132 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7133 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7134 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7135 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7136 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7137 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7138 redirected to another valid server.
7139
7140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7142
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007143 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007144
7145
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007146option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7147 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 yes | no | yes | yes
7150 Arguments :
7151 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7152 PostgreSQL server.
7153
7154 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7155 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7156 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7157 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7158
7159 See also: "option httpchk"
7160
7161
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007162option prefer-last-server
7163no option prefer-last-server
7164 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | no | yes | yes
7167 Arguments : none
7168
7169 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7170 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7171 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7172 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7173 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7174 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7175 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7176 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7177 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007178 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7179 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007180 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7181 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7182 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007183 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7184 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7185 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007186
7187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7189
7190 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7191
7192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007193option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007194option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007195no option redispatch
7196 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007199 Arguments :
7200 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7201 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7202 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007203 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007204 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007205 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007206 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7207 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7208 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007210
7211 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7212 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7213 be able to access the service anymore.
7214
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007215 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7216 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007217
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007218 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007219 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7220 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007222 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7223 "redisp" keywords.
7224
7225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7227
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007228 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007229
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007230
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007231option redis-check
7232 Use redis health checks for server testing
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | no | yes | yes
7235 Arguments : none
7236
7237 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7238 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7239 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7240 find the "+PONG" response message.
7241
7242 Example :
7243 option redis-check
7244
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007245 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007246
7247
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007248option smtpchk
7249option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7250 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7252 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007253 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007254 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007255 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007256 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7257
7258 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7259 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7260 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7261
7262 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7263 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7264 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7265 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7266 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7267 dead server.
7268
7269 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7270 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007271 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007272 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7273
7274 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7275 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7276 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7277 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007278 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007279
7280 Example :
7281 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7282
7283 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007286option socket-stats
7287no option socket-stats
7288
7289 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 yes | yes | yes | no
7292
7293 Arguments : none
7294
7295
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007296option splice-auto
7297no option splice-auto
7298 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 yes | yes | yes | yes
7301 Arguments : none
7302
7303 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7304 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007305 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007306 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007307 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007308 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7309 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7310 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7311 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7312
7313 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7314 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7315 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7316 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7317 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7318 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7319 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7320 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7321 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7322 keyword.
7323
7324 Example :
7325 option splice-auto
7326
7327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7329
7330 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7331 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7332
7333
7334option splice-request
7335no option splice-request
7336 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 yes | yes | yes | yes
7339 Arguments : none
7340
7341 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007342 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007343 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7344 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7345 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7346 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7347
7348 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7349
7350 Example :
7351 option splice-request
7352
7353 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7354 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7355
7356 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7357 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7358
7359
7360option splice-response
7361no option splice-response
7362 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 yes | yes | yes | yes
7365 Arguments : none
7366
7367 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007368 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007369 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7370 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7371 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7372 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7373
7374 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7375
7376 Example :
7377 option splice-response
7378
7379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7381
7382 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7383 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7384
7385
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007386option spop-check
7387 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7389 no | no | no | yes
7390 Arguments : none
7391
7392 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7393 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7394 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7395 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7396
7397 Example :
7398 option spop-check
7399
7400 See also : "option httpchk"
7401
7402
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007403option srvtcpka
7404no option srvtcpka
7405 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 yes | no | yes | yes
7408 Arguments : none
7409
7410 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7411 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007412 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007413 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7414
7415 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7416 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7417 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7418 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7419
7420 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7421 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7422 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7423 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7424 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7425
7426 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7427
7428 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7429 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7430 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7431
7432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7434
7435 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7436
7437
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007438option ssl-hello-chk
7439 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442 Arguments : none
7443
7444 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7445 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7446 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7447 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7448 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7449 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7450 hello message.
7451
7452 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7453 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7454 messages, which is appreciable.
7455
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007456 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7457 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7458 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007459
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007460 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7461
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007462
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007463option tcp-check
7464 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7466 yes | no | yes | yes
7467
7468 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7469 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7470
7471 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7472 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7473 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7474
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007475 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007476 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7477 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7478 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7479 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7480 only.
7481
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007482 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007483 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7484 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7485 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7486 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007488 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007489 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7490 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007491 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007492 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7493 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7494 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7495 the respective protocols.
7496 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007497 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007498
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007499 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7500 script.
7501
7502 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7503 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7504 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7505 The "comment" is of course optional.
7506
7507
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007508 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007509 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007510 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007511 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007512
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007513 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007514 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007515 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007516
7517 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7518 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007520 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007521 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007522 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007523 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007524 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007525 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7526 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007527 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007528 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7529 tcp-check expect string +OK
7530
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007531 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007532 (send many headers before analyzing)
7533 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007534 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007535 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7536 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7537 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7538 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007539 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007540
7541
7542 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7543
7544
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007545option tcp-smart-accept
7546no option tcp-smart-accept
7547 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7549 yes | yes | yes | no
7550 Arguments : none
7551
7552 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7553 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7554 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7555 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7556 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7557 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7558
7559 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7560 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7561 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7562 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7563
7564 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7565 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7566 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007567 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007568
7569 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7570 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7571 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7572
7573 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7574 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7575 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7576
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007577 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7578
7579
7580option tcp-smart-connect
7581no option tcp-smart-connect
7582 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 yes | no | yes | yes
7585 Arguments : none
7586
7587 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7588 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7589 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7590 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7591 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7592
7593 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7594 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7595 complex.
7596
7597 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7598 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7599 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7600
7601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7603
7604 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7605
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007606
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007607option tcpka
7608 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 yes | yes | yes | yes
7611 Arguments : none
7612
7613 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7614 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007615 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007616 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7617
7618 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7619 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7620 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7621 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7622
7623 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7624 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7625 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7626 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7627 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7628
7629 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7630
7631 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7632 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7633 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7634 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7635 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7636 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7637 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7638 backends.
7639
7640 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7641
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007642
7643option tcplog
7644 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007646 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007647 Arguments : none
7648
7649 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7650 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7651 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7652 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7653 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7654 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7655 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7656 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7657
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007658 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007660 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007661
7662
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007663option transparent
7664no option transparent
7665 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007667 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007668 Arguments : none
7669
7670 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7671 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7672 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7673 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7674 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7675 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7676 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7677 appropriate server.
7678
7679 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7680 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7681
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007682 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007683 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007684
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007685
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007686external-check command <command>
7687 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7689 yes | no | yes | yes
7690
7691 Arguments :
7692 <command> is the external command to run
7693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007694 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7695
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007696 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007697
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007698 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7699 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7700 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7701 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7702 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7703 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007704
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007705 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7706
7707 Environment variables :
7708 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7709 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7710
7711 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7712
7713 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7714
7715 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7716 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7717 for a UNIX socket).
7718
7719 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7720
7721 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7722
7723 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7724
7725 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7726
7727 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7728
7729 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7730 socket).
7731
7732 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7733 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007735 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7736
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007737 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7738 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7739 failed.
7740
7741 Example :
7742 external-check command /bin/true
7743
7744 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7745
7746
7747external-check path <path>
7748 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | no | yes | yes
7751
7752 Arguments :
7753 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7754
7755 The default path is "".
7756
7757 Example :
7758 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7759
7760 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7761 "external-check command"
7762
7763
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007764persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007765persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007766 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7768 yes | no | yes | yes
7769 Arguments :
7770 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007771 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7772 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007773
7774 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7775 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007776 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007777 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7778 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7779 forwarded to this server.
7780
7781 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7782 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7783 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007784 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007785 a single "listen" section.
7786
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007787 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7788 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7789 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7790
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007791 Example :
7792 listen tse-farm
7793 bind :3389
7794 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7795 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7796 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7797 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7798 persist rdp-cookie
7799 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007800 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007801 balance rdp-cookie
7802 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7803 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7804
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007805 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7806 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007807
7808
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007809rate-limit sessions <rate>
7810 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 yes | yes | yes | no
7813 Arguments :
7814 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7815 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7816
7817 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7818 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7819 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7820 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7821 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7822 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7823
7824 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7825 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7826 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7827 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7828
7829 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7830 listen smtp
7831 mode tcp
7832 bind :25
7833 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007834 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007835
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007836 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7837 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7838 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007839
7840 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7841
7842
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007843redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7844redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7845redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007846 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 no | yes | yes | yes
7849
7850 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007851 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007852
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007854 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007855 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7856 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7857 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007858
7859 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7860 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7861 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7862 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7863 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007864 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7865 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7866 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7867 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007868
7869 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7870 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7871 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7872 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7873 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7874 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007875 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007876 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007877 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7878 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7879 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007880
7881 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007882 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7883 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7884 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007885 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007886 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7887 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7888 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7889 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007890
7891 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007892 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007893
7894 - "drop-query"
7895 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7896 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7897 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7898 with a location-type redirect.
7899
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007900 - "append-slash"
7901 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7902 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7903 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7904 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7905
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007906 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7907 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7908 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7909 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7910 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7911 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7912 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7913
7914 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7915 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7916 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7917 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7918 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7919 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7920 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007921
7922 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7923 acl clear dst_port 80
7924 acl secure dst_port 8080
7925 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007926 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007927 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007928 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7929
7930 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007931 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7932 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7933 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007934 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007935
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007936 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7937 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7938 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7939
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007940 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007941 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007942
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007943 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007944 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7945 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7946 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007948 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007949
7950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007951redisp (deprecated)
7952redispatch (deprecated)
7953 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007956 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007957
7958 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7959 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7960 be able to access the service anymore.
7961
7962 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7963 redistribute them to a working server.
7964
7965 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7966 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7967 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007969 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7970 "option redispatch" instead.
7971
7972 See also : "option redispatch"
7973
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007975reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007976 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7978 no | yes | yes | yes
7979 Arguments :
7980 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7981 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007982 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007984 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7985 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7986
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007987 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7988 the last header of an HTTP request.
7989
7990 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7991 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7992 responses.
7993
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007994 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7995 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7996 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7997
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007998 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7999 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008000
8001
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008002reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8003reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008004 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8006 no | yes | yes | yes
8007 Arguments :
8008 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8009 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8010 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8011 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8012 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8013 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8014 ignores case.
8015
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008016 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8017 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8018
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008019 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8020 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8021 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8022 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008023 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008024
8025 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8026 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8027
8028 Example :
8029 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8030 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8031 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8032
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008033 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8034 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008035
8036
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008037reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8038reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008039 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 no | yes | yes | yes
8042 Arguments :
8043 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8044 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8045 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8046 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8047 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8048 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8049
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008050 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8051 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8052
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008053 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8054 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8055 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8056 next servers.
8057
8058 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8059 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8060 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8061
8062 Example :
8063 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8064 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8065 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8066
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008067 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8068 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008069
8070
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008071reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8072reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008073 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 no | yes | yes | yes
8076 Arguments :
8077 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8078 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8079 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8080 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8081 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8082 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8083 case.
8084
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008085 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8086 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8087
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008088 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8089 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8090 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8091 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008092 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008093
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008094 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008095 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008096 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008097
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008098 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8099 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8100
8101 Example :
8102 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8103 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8104 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8105
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008106 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8107 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008108
8109
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008110reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8111reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008112 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8114 no | yes | yes | yes
8115 Arguments :
8116 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8117 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8118 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8119 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8120 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8121 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8122 case.
8123
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008124 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8125 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8126
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008127 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8128 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8129 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8130 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8131
8132 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8133 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8134
8135 Example :
8136 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8137 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8138 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8139 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8140
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008141 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8142 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008143
8144
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008145reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8146reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008147 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 no | yes | yes | yes
8150 Arguments :
8151 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8152 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8153 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8154 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8155 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8156 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8157
8158 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8159 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8160 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8161 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008162 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008163
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008164 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8165 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8166
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008167 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8168 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8169 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8170
8171 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8172 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8173 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8174 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8175 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8176
8177 Example :
8178 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008179 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008180 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8181 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8182
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008183 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8184 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008185
8186
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008187reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8188reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008189 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 no | yes | yes | yes
8192 Arguments :
8193 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8194 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8195 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8196 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8197 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8198 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8199 ignores case.
8200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008201 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8202 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8203
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008204 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8205 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008206 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8207 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8208 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008209 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8210 not set.
8211
8212 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8213 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8214 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8215 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8216 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8217
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008218 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008219 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008220 # block all others.
8221 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8222 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008224 # block bad guys
8225 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8226 reqitarpit . if badguys
8227
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008228 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8229 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008230
8231
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008232retries <value>
8233 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8235 yes | no | yes | yes
8236 Arguments :
8237 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8238 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8239 default value is 3.
8240
8241 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8242 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8243 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8244
8245 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008246 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8247 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008248
8249 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8250 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8251
8252 See also : "option redispatch"
8253
8254
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008255retry-on [list of keywords]
8256 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8258 yes | no | yes | yes
8259 Arguments :
8260 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8261 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8262 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8263 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8264
8265 none never retry
8266
8267 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8268 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8269
8270 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8271 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8272 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8273 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8274 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8275 processing the request.
8276
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008277 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8278 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8279 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8280 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8281 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8282 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8283 overflow attack for example).
8284
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008285 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8286 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8287 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8288 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8289 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8290 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8291 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8292 amplify denial of service attacks.
8293
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008294 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8295 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8296 considered to be safe to retry.
8297
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008298 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8299 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8300 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8301 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8302
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008303 all-retryable-errors
8304 retry request for any error that are considered
8305 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8306 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8307 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8308
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008309 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8310 not cumulative.
8311
8312 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8313 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8314 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8315 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8316
8317 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8318 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8319 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8320 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8321 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8322 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8323 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8324 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8325 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8326 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8327 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8328 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8329
8330 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8331 should not use this directive.
8332
8333 The default is "conn-failure".
8334
8335 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8336
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008337rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008338 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8340 no | yes | yes | yes
8341 Arguments :
8342 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8343 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008344 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008345
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008346 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8347 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8348
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008349 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8350 the last header of an HTTP response.
8351
8352 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8353 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8354 responses.
8355
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008356 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8357 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008358
8359
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008360rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8361rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008362 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 no | yes | yes | yes
8365 Arguments :
8366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8367 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8368 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8369 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8370 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8371 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8372 ignores case.
8373
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008374 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8375 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8376
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008377 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8378 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008379 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008380 client.
8381
8382 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8383 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8384 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8385
8386 Example :
8387 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008388 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008389
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008390 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8391 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008392
8393
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008394rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8395rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008396 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 no | yes | yes | yes
8399 Arguments :
8400 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8401 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8402 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8403 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8404 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8405 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8406 ignores case.
8407
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008408 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8409 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8410
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008411 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8412 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8413 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8414 case-sensitive.
8415
8416 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008417 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8418 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8419 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008420
8421 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8422 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8423
8424 Example :
8425 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8426 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8427
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008428 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8429 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008430
8431
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008432rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8433rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008434 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 no | yes | yes | yes
8437 Arguments :
8438 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8439 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8440 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8441 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8442 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8443 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8444 ignores case.
8445
8446 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8447 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8448 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8449 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008450 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008451
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008452 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8453 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8454
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008455 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8456 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8457 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8458
8459 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8460 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8461 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8462 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8463 are not case-sensitive.
8464
8465 Example :
8466 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8467 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8468
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008469 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8470 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008471
8472
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008473server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008474 Declare a server in a backend
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 no | no | yes | yes
8477 Arguments :
8478 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008479 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008480 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008481
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008482 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8483 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8484 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8485 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008486 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8487 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8488 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8489 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8490 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008491 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8492 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8493 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8494 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8495 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8496 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8497 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008498 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008499 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8500 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8501 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8502 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8503 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8504 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008505 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8506 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008507 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8508 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008509
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008510 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008511 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8512 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8513 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8514 adding this value to the client's port.
8515
8516 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8517 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008518 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008519
8520 Examples :
8521 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8522 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008523 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008524 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8525 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8526 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008527
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008528 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8529 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8530 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8531 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8532 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8533
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008534 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8535 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008536
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008537server-state-file-name [<file>]
8538 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8539 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8540 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8541 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8542 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8543 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8544
8545 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8546 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8547
8548 global
8549 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8550
8551 backend bk
8552 load-server-state-from-file
8553
8554 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8555 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008556
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008557server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8558 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8559 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 no | no | yes | yes
8562
8563 Arguments:
8564 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8565
8566 <num | range>
8567 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8568 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8569 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8570 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8571
8572 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8573
8574 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8575
8576 <params*>
8577 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8578 keyword.
8579
8580 Examples:
8581 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8582 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8583 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8584
8585 # or
8586 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8587
8588 # would be equivalent to:
8589 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8590 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8591 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8592
8593
8594
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008595source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008596source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008597source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8600 yes | no | yes | yes
8601 Arguments :
8602 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8603 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008604
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008605 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008606 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8607 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8608 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8609 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8610 supported prefixes are :
8611 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8612 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8613 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008614 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008615 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8616 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617
8618 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8619 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008620 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8621 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8622 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008623
8624 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8625 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8626 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8627 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8628 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8629 <addr>.
8630
8631 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8632 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8633 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8634 port.
8635
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008636 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8637 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8638 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8639 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008640 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008641 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8642 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8643 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8644 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8645 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8646 HTTP header.
8647
8648 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8649 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008650 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008651 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8652 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8653 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8654 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8655 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8656 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8657 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8658
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008659 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8660 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8661 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8662 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8663 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8664 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8667 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8668 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8669 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8670
8671 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8672 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8673 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8674 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8675 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8676 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8677
8678 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8679 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8680 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8681 there are two methods :
8682
8683 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8684 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8685 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8686 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8687 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8688 of the client ranges may be used.
8689
8690 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8691 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8692 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8693 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8694 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8695 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8696 same session.
8697
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008698 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8699 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8700 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008701 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008702
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008703 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8704
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008705 Examples :
8706 backend private
8707 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8708 source 192.168.1.200
8709
8710 backend transparent_ssl1
8711 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8712 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8713
8714 backend transparent_ssl2
8715 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8716 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8717 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8718
8719 backend transparent_ssl3
8720 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8721 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8722 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8723
8724 backend transparent_smtp
8725 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8726 # with Tproxy version 4.
8727 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8728
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008729 backend transparent_http
8730 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8731 # proxy.
8732 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008734 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008737
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008738srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8739 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8741 yes | no | yes | yes
8742 Arguments :
8743 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8744 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8745 as explained at the top of this document.
8746
8747 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8748 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8749 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8750 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8751 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8752 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8753 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8754
8755 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8756 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8757 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8758 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8759 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008760 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008761 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008762 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008763
8764 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8766 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8767 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8768 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8769 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8770
8771 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8772 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8773
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008774 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8775 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008776
8777
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008778stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8779 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008781 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008782
8783 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8784 matched.
8785
8786 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8787 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8788
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008789 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8790 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008791 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008792
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008793 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8794 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8795 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8796 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008797
8798 Example :
8799 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8800 backend stats_localhost
8801 stats enable
8802 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8803
8804 Example :
8805 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8806 backend stats_auth
8807 stats enable
8808 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8809 stats admin if TRUE
8810
8811 Example :
8812 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8813 userlist stats-auth
8814 group admin users admin
8815 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8816 group readonly users haproxy
8817 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8818
8819 backend stats_auth
8820 stats enable
8821 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8822 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8823 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8824 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8825
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008826 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8827 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8828 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008829
8830
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008831stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8832 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008834 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008835 Arguments :
8836 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8837
8838 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8839
8840 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8841 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8842 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8843 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8844 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8845 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8846
8847 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8848 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8849 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008850 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008851
8852 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8853 report using "stats scope".
8854
8855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8857 unobvious parameters.
8858
8859 Example :
8860 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8861 backend public_www
8862 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8863 stats enable
8864 stats hide-version
8865 stats scope .
8866 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008867 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008868 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8869 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8870
8871 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8872 backend private_monitoring
8873 stats enable
8874 stats uri /admin?stats
8875 stats refresh 5s
8876
8877 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8878
8879
8880stats enable
8881 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008884 Arguments : none
8885
8886 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8887 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8888 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8889 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8890 - stats auth : no authentication
8891 - stats scope : no restriction
8892
8893 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8894 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8895 unobvious parameters.
8896
8897 Example :
8898 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8899 backend public_www
8900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8901 stats enable
8902 stats hide-version
8903 stats scope .
8904 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008905 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008906 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8907 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8908
8909 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8910 backend private_monitoring
8911 stats enable
8912 stats uri /admin?stats
8913 stats refresh 5s
8914
8915 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8916
8917
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008918stats hide-version
8919 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008924 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8925 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8926 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8927 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8928 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8929 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008931 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8932 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8933 unobvious parameters.
8934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008935 Example :
8936 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8937 backend public_www
8938 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008939 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 stats hide-version
8941 stats scope .
8942 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008943 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008944 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8945 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008946
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008947 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8948 backend private_monitoring
8949 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950 stats uri /admin?stats
8951 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008952
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008953 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008954
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008955
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008956stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8957 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8958 Access control for statistics
8959
8960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8961 no | no | yes | yes
8962
8963 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8964 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8965 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8966 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8967 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8968 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8969
8970 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8971 instance.
8972
8973 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8974 about ACL usage.
8975
8976
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008977stats realm <realm>
8978 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008981 Arguments :
8982 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8983 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8984 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8985
8986 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8987 using a backslash ('\').
8988
8989 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8990 only related to authentication.
8991
8992 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8993 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8994 unobvious parameters.
8995
8996 Example :
8997 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8998 backend public_www
8999 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9000 stats enable
9001 stats hide-version
9002 stats scope .
9003 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009004 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009005 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9006 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9007
9008 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9009 backend private_monitoring
9010 stats enable
9011 stats uri /admin?stats
9012 stats refresh 5s
9013
9014 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9015
9016
9017stats refresh <delay>
9018 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009020 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009021 Arguments :
9022 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9023 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9024 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9025 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9026 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9027 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9028
9029 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9030 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9031 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9032 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9033
9034 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9035 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9036 unobvious parameters.
9037
9038 Example :
9039 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9040 backend public_www
9041 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9042 stats enable
9043 stats hide-version
9044 stats scope .
9045 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009046 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009047 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9048 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9049
9050 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9051 backend private_monitoring
9052 stats enable
9053 stats uri /admin?stats
9054 stats refresh 5s
9055
9056 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9057
9058
9059stats scope { <name> | "." }
9060 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009062 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009063 Arguments :
9064 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9065 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9066 section in which the statement appears.
9067
9068 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9069 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9070 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9071 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9072 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9073 exists.
9074
9075 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9076 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9077 unobvious parameters.
9078
9079 Example :
9080 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9081 backend public_www
9082 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9083 stats enable
9084 stats hide-version
9085 stats scope .
9086 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9089 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9090
9091 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9092 backend private_monitoring
9093 stats enable
9094 stats uri /admin?stats
9095 stats refresh 5s
9096
9097 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009099
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009100stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009101 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009103 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009104
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009105 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009106 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9107
9108 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9109 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9110
9111 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9112 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009113 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009114
9115 Example :
9116 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9117 backend private_monitoring
9118 stats enable
9119 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9120 stats uri /admin?stats
9121 stats refresh 5s
9122
9123 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9124 global section.
9125
9126
9127stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009128 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9130 yes | yes | yes | yes
9131 Arguments : none
9132
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009133 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009134 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9135 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9136 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9137 - IP (socket, server)
9138 - cookie (backend, server)
9139
9140 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9141 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009142 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009143
9144 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9145
9146
9147stats show-node [ <name> ]
9148 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009151 Arguments:
9152 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9153 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9154
9155 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9156 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009157 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009158
9159 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9160 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9161 unobvious parameters.
9162
9163 Example:
9164 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9165 backend private_monitoring
9166 stats enable
9167 stats show-node Europe-1
9168 stats uri /admin?stats
9169 stats refresh 5s
9170
9171 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9172 section.
9173
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009174
9175stats uri <prefix>
9176 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009178 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009179 Arguments :
9180 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9181 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9182 query string.
9183
9184 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9185 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9186 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9187 possible to reach it in the application.
9188
9189 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009190 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009191 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9192 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9193 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9194 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9195
9196 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9197 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9198 an address or a port to statistics only.
9199
9200 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9201 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9202 unobvious parameters.
9203
9204 Example :
9205 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9206 backend public_www
9207 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9208 stats enable
9209 stats hide-version
9210 stats scope .
9211 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009212 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009213 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9214 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9215
9216 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9217 backend private_monitoring
9218 stats enable
9219 stats uri /admin?stats
9220 stats refresh 5s
9221
9222 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9223
9224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009225stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9226 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009228 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009229
9230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009231 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009232 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009234 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9235
9236 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9237 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9238 the "stick-table" statement.
9239
9240 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9241 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9242 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9243 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9244 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9245
9246 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9247 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9248 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9249 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9250 transformation rules.
9251
9252 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9253 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9254 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9255 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9256 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9257 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9258 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9259
9260 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9261 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9262 ACL based conditions.
9263
9264 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9265 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9266 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9267 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9268
9269 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9270 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9271 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9272 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9273
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009274 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9275 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009276 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009277
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009278 Example :
9279 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9280 # last 30 minutes
9281 backend pop
9282 mode tcp
9283 balance roundrobin
9284 stick store-request src
9285 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9286 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9287 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9288
9289 backend smtp
9290 mode tcp
9291 balance roundrobin
9292 stick match src table pop
9293 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9294 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9295
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009296 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009297 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009298
9299
9300stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9301 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9303 no | no | yes | yes
9304
9305 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9306 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9307 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9308 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9309
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009310 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9311 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009313
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009314 Examples :
9315 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009316 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009317
9318 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9319 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9320 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9321
9322
9323 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9324 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9325 backend http
9326 mode http
9327 balance roundrobin
9328 stick on src table https
9329 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9330 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9331 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9332
9333 backend https
9334 mode tcp
9335 balance roundrobin
9336 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9337 stick on src
9338 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9339 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9340
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009341 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009342
9343
9344stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9345 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9347 no | no | yes | yes
9348
9349 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009350 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009351 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009352 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009353 server is selected.
9354
9355 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9356 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9357 the "stick-table" statement.
9358
9359 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9360 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9361 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9362 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9363 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9364 address.
9365
9366 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9367 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9368 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9369 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9370 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9371 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9372 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9373 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9374 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9375 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9376
9377 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9378 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9379 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9380 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9381 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9382 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9383 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9384
9385 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9386 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9387 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9388 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9389
9390 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9391 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9392 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9393 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9394 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9395 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009396 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9397 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9398 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9399 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9400 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9401 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009402
9403 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9404 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9405 the request.
9406
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009407 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9408 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009409 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009410
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009411 Example :
9412 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9413 # last 30 minutes
9414 backend pop
9415 mode tcp
9416 balance roundrobin
9417 stick store-request src
9418 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9419 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9420 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9421
9422 backend smtp
9423 mode tcp
9424 balance roundrobin
9425 stick match src table pop
9426 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9427 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9428
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009429 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009430 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009431
9432
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009433stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009434 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9435 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009436 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009438 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009439
9440 Arguments :
9441 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9442 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9443 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9444 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9445
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009446 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9447 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9448 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9449 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9450
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009451 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9452 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9453 instance.
9454
9455 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9456 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9457 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9458 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9459 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9460 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009461 to 32 characters.
9462
9463 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9464 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9465 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009466 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009467 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9468 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469
9470 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009471 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9472 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009473 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9474 increase.
9475
9476 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009477 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9478 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9479 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009480
9481 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9482 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9483 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9484 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009485 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009486 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9487 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9488 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9489 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9490 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9491 parameter (see below).
9492
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009493 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9494 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9495 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9496 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9497 soft restart.
9498
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009499 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9500 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009501
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009502 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9503 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9504 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9505 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009506 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009507 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009508 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9509 if not expiration delay is specified.
9510
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009511 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9512 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9513 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9514 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009515 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9516 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9517 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9518 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9519 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9520 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9521 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9522 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9523 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9524 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9525 types and their arguments.
9526
9527 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9528 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9529 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9530 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9531
9532 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9533 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9534 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009535 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009536
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009537 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9538 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9539 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009540 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009541 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009542 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009543
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009544 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9545 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9546 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9547 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9548
9549 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9550 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9551 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9552 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9553 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9554 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9555
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009556 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9557 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9558 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9559 they were received.
9560
9561 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9562 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9563 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9564 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9565 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9566
9567 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9568 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9569 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9570 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9571 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9572
9573 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9574 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9575 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9576
9577 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9578 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9579 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9580 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9581 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9582
9583 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9584 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9585 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9586 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9587 the client side.
9588
9589 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9590 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9591 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9592 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9593 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9594 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9595 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9596
9597 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9598 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9599 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9600 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9601 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9602 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009603 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009604
9605 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9606 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9607 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9608 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9609 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9610 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9611
9612 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009613 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009614 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9615 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9616
9617 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9618 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9619 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9620 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9621 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9622 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9623 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9624 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9625 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9626 recommended for better fairness.
9627
9628 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009629 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009630 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9631 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9632
9633 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9634 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9636 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9637 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9638 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9639 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9640 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9641 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9642 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009643
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009644 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9645 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009646 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9647 reference it.
9648
9649 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9650 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009651 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9652 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9653 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009654
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009655 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9656 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9657 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9658 something that can be ignored.
9659
9660 Example:
9661 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9662 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9663 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9664 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9665
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009666 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009667 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009668
9669
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009670stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009671 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 no | no | yes | yes
9674
9675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009676 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009677 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009678 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009679 server is selected.
9680
9681 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9682 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9683 the "stick-table" statement.
9684
9685 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9686 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9687 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9688 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9689
9690 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9691 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9692 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9693 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9694 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9695 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009696 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009697 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9698 rules.
9699
9700 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9701 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9702 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9703 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9704 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9705 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9706 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9707
9708 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9709 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9710 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9711 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9712
9713 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9714 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9715 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9716 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9717 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9718 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009719 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9720 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9721 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9722 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9723 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9724 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9725 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9726 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9727 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009728
9729 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9730
9731 Example :
9732 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9733 backend https
9734 mode tcp
9735 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009736 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009737 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009738
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009739 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9740 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9741
9742 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9743 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9744 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9745
9746 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9747 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009748
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009749 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9750 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9751 # at offset 44.
9752
9753 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9754 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9755
9756 # Learn on response if server hello.
9757 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009758
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009759 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9760 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9761
9762 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9763 extraction.
9764
9765
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009766tcp-check connect [params*]
9767 Opens a new connection
9768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9769 no | no | yes | yes
9770
9771 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9772 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9773 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9774
9775 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9776 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9777 of the sequence.
9778
9779 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9780 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9781 do.
9782
9783 Parameters :
9784 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9785 use the TCP connection.
9786
9787 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9788 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9789 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9790
9791 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9792
9793 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9794
9795 Examples:
9796 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9797 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9798 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9799 option tcp-check
9800 tcp-check connect
9801 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9802 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9803 tcp-check send \r\n
9804 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9805 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9806 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9807 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9808 tcp-check send \r\n
9809 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9810 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9811
9812 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9813 option tcp-check
9814 tcp-check connect port 110
9815 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9816 tcp-check connect port 143
9817 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9818 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9819
9820 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9821
9822
9823tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009824 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9826 no | no | yes | yes
9827
9828 Arguments :
9829 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9830 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9831 binary.
9832 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9833 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9834 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9835
9836 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9837 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9838 with the usual backslash ('\').
9839 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009840 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009841 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9842 used upper or lower case.
9843
9844
9845 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9846
9847 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9848 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9849 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9850 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9851 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9852 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9853 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9854 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9855
9856 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9858 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9859 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9860 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9861 expression.
9862
9863 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9864 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9865 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9866 this exact hexadecimal string.
9867 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9868
9869 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9870 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9871 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9872 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9873 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9874 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9875 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9876 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9877 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9878 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9879 the null character.
9880
9881 Examples :
9882 # perform a POP check
9883 option tcp-check
9884 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9885
9886 # perform an IMAP check
9887 option tcp-check
9888 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9889
9890 # look for the redis master server
9891 option tcp-check
9892 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009893 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009894 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9895 tcp-check expect string role:master
9896 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9897 tcp-check expect string +OK
9898
9899
9900 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9901 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9902
9903
9904tcp-check send <data>
9905 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9907 no | no | yes | yes
9908
9909 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9910 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9911
9912 Examples :
9913 # look for the redis master server
9914 option tcp-check
9915 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9916 tcp-check expect string role:master
9917
9918 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9919 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9920
9921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009922tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9923 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009924 tcp health check
9925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9926 no | no | yes | yes
9927
9928 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9929 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009930 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009931 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9932 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9933 hexadecimal string.
9934 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9935
9936 Examples :
9937 # redis check in binary
9938 option tcp-check
9939 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9940 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9941
9942
9943 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9944 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9945
9946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009947tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9948 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9950 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009952 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9953 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009955 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009956
9957 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9958 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009959 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9960 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9961 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9962 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9963 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9964 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009966 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9967 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9968 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9969 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009970
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009971 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009972 - accept :
9973 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9974 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9975 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009977 - reject :
9978 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9980 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9981 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9982 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9983 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9984 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9985 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9986 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9987 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9988 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009989 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009990
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009991 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9992 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9993 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9994 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9995 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9996 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9997 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9998 hosts.
9999
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010000 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10001 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10002 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10003 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10004 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10005 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10006 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10007 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10008
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010009 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10010 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10011 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10012 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10013 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10014 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10015 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10016 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10017 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010018 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10019 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010020
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010021 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010022 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010023 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10024 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10025 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010026 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010027 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10028 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10029 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10030 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10031 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10032 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10033 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10034 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010036 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010037 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010040 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10041 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10042 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010044 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10045 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10046 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10047 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10050 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10051 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10052 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10053 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010054 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10055 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10056 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10057 layer7 information is extracted.
10058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010059 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10060 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10061 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10062 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10063 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010064
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010065 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10066 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10067 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10068 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10069
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010070 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10071 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10072 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10073 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10074
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010075 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10076 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10077 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10078 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10079 continues.
10080
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010081 - set-src <expr> :
10082 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10083 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10084 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010085 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010087 Arguments:
10088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10089 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010090
10091 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010092 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10093
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010094 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10095 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010096
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010097 - set-src-port <expr> :
10098 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10099 expression.
10100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010101 Arguments:
10102 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10103 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010104
10105 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010106 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10107
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010108 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10109 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10110 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010111
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010112 - set-dst <expr> :
10113 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10114 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10115 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10116 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10117 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10118
10119 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10120 followed by some converters.
10121
10122 Example:
10123
10124 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10125 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10126
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010127 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10128 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10129
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010130 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10131 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10132 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10133 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10134
10135
10136 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10137 followed by some converters.
10138
10139 Example:
10140
10141 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10142
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010143 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10144 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10145 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10146
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010147 - "silent-drop" :
10148 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010149 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010150 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10151 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10152 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10153 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10154 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010155 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10156 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010157 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10158 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010159 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010160 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10161 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10162 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10163 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010165 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10166 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10167 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010169 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10170 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10171 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010173 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010174 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010175 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010177 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10178 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10179 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010181 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010182 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10183 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010184
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010185 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10186
10187 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10188
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010189 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10190
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010191 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010192
10193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010194tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10195 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010197 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010198 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010199 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10200 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010201
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010202 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010204 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10206 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10207 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10208 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010209
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010210 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10211 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10212 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10213 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010214 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10215 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10216 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10217 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10218 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10219 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010220 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010221 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010223 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10224 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10225 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10226 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010227
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010228 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010229 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010230 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010231 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10232 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010233 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010234 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010235 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010236 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010237 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010238 - set-dst <expr>
10239 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010240 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010241 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010242 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010243 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010244 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010246 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10247 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010248 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10249 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010251 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10252 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10253 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10254 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10255 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10256 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010258 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010259 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10260 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010262 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010263 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10264 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10265 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10266 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010267 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10268 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10269 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010270
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010271 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010272 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10273 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10274 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010275
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010276 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10277 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10278
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010279 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010280 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10281 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010282
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010283 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10284 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010285 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010286 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10287 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010288 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010289 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010290 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010291 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10292 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010293 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010294 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10295 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010296
10297 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10298 followed by some converters.
10299
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010300 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10301 <var-name>.
10302
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010303 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10304 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10305 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10306 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10307 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10308
10309 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10310 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10311 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10312 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10313 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10314 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10315 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10316 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10317 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10318 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10319 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10320
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010321 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10322 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10323 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10324 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10325 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10326
10327 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10328
10329 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10330
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010331 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10332 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10333 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10334 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10335 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10336 evaluated.
10337
10338 Example:
10339 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10340
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010341 Example:
10342
10343 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010344 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010345
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010346 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010347 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10348 # and reject everything else.
10349 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10350 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010351 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010352 tcp-request content reject
10353
10354 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010355 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10356 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10357 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010358 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010359
10360 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10361 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10362 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010363 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010364 tcp-request content reject
10365
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010366 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010367 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010368 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010369 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010370 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10371 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010372
10373 Example:
10374 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10375 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010376 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010378 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010379 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380
10381 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010382 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 # protecting all our sites
10384 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010385 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10386 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010387 ...
10388 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10389
10390 backend http_dynamic
10391 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010392 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010393 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010394 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010395 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010396 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010397 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010399 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010400
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010401 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10402 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010403
10404
10405tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10406 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010408 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010409 Arguments :
10410 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10412 as explained at the top of this document.
10413
10414 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10415 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10416 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10417 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10418 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10419
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010420 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10421 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10422 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10423 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10424
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010425 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10426 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010427 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010428 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010429 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10430 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10431 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10432 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010433
10434 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10435 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10436 it pass through unaffected.
10437
10438 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10439 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10440 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010441 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010442 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10443 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010444 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10445 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10446 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010447
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010448 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010449 "timeout client".
10450
10451
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010452tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10453 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 no | no | yes | yes
10456 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010457 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10458 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010459
10460 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10461
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010463 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10464 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010465 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10466 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010467
10468 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10469
10470 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10471 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10472 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10473 inserted.
10474
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010475 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010476 - accept :
10477 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10478 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10479 the rules evaluation.
10480
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010481 - close :
10482 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10483 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10484 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10485 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10486 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10487 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010488 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010489 protocols.
10490
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010491 - reject :
10492 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10493 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010494 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010495
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010496 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10497 Sets a variable.
10498
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010499 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10500 Unsets a variable.
10501
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010502 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10503 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10504 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10505 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10506
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010507 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10508 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10509 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10510 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10511
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010512 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10513 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10514 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10515 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10516 continues.
10517
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010518 - "silent-drop" :
10519 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010520 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010521 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10522 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10523 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10524 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10525 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010526 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10527 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010528 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10529 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010531 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10532 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10533 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10534 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10535
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010536 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10537 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10538
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010539 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10540 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10541 for changing the default action to a reject.
10542
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010543 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10544 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10545 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10546 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010547 period.
10548
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010549 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10550 declared inline.
10551
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010552 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10553 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010554 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010555 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10556 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010557 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010558 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010559 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010560 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10561 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010562 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010563 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10564 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010565
10566 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10567 followed by some converters.
10568
10569 Example:
10570
10571 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10572
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010573 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10574 <var-name>.
10575
10576 Example:
10577
10578 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10579
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010580 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10581 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10582 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10583 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10584 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10585
10586 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10587
10588 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10589
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010590 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10591
10592 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10593
10594
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010595tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10596 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10598 no | yes | yes | no
10599 Arguments :
10600 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10601 below.
10602
10603 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010605 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010606 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10607 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10608 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10609 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10610 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10611 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10612 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010613 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010614 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10615 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10616 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10617 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10618 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10619 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10620 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10621 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10622 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10623 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10624 instead.
10625
10626 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10627 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10628 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10629 rules which may be inserted.
10630
10631 Several types of actions are supported :
10632 - accept : the request is accepted
10633 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10634 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10635 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010636 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010637 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10638 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010639 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010640 - silent-drop
10641
10642 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10643 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10644 sections for a complete description.
10645
10646 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10647 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10648 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10649
10650 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10651 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10652 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10653 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10654 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10655
10656 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10657 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10658
10659 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10660 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10661 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10662
10663 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10664 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10665 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10666
10667 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10668 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10669 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10670
10671 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10672 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10673 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10674
10675 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10676
10677 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10678
10679
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010680tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10681 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 no | no | yes | yes
10684 Arguments :
10685 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10686 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10687 as explained at the top of this document.
10688
10689 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10690
10691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010692timeout check <timeout>
10693 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10694 established.
10695
10696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10697 yes | no | yes | yes
10698 Arguments:
10699 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10700 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10701 as explained at the top of this document.
10702
10703 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10704 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010705 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010706 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010707 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10708 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10709 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010710
10711 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10712 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10713
10714 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10715 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010716 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010717
10718 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10719 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10720 forget about it.
10721
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010722 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10723 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010724
10725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010726timeout client <timeout>
10727timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10728 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10730 yes | yes | yes | no
10731 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10734 as explained at the top of this document.
10735
10736 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10737 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10738 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010739 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10740 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10741 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10742 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010743 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10744 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10745 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010746 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010747 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010748 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10749 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010750 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10751 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010752
10753 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10754 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10755 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10756 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010757 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010758 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10759
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010760 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010762 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10763 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10764 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10765
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010766 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10767 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010768
10769
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010770timeout client-fin <timeout>
10771 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10773 yes | yes | yes | no
10774 Arguments :
10775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10777 as explained at the top of this document.
10778
10779 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10780 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10781 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10782 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10783 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10784 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10785 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010786 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10787 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10788 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010789
10790 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10791 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10792 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10793
10794 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10795
10796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010797timeout connect <timeout>
10798timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10799 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10801 yes | no | yes | yes
10802 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010803 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10805 as explained at the top of this document.
10806
10807 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010808 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010809 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010810 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010811 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10812 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010813
10814 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10816 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10817 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010818 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010819 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10820
10821 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10822 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10823 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10824
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010825 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10826 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010827
10828
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010829timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10830 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10832 yes | yes | yes | yes
10833 Arguments :
10834 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10835 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10836 as explained at the top of this document.
10837
10838 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10839 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10840 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10841 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10842 once the request has started to present itself.
10843
10844 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10845 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10846 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10847 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10848 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10849
10850 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10851 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10852 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10853 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10854
10855 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10856 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010857 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010858 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10859 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010860 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010861
10862 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10863 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10864 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10865 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10866
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010867 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10868 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010869 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10870
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010871 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10872
10873
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010874timeout http-request <timeout>
10875 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010878 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010879 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010880 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10881 as explained at the top of this document.
10882
10883 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10884 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10885 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10886 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10887 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10888 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10889 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010890 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10891 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10892 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10893 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010894 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010895 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10896 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010897
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010898 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10899 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10900 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10901 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10902 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010903 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010904
10905 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10906 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010907 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010908 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10909 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10910
10911 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010912 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10913 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10914 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010915
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010916 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010917 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010918
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010919
10920timeout queue <timeout>
10921 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10923 yes | no | yes | yes
10924 Arguments :
10925 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10926 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10927 as explained at the top of this document.
10928
10929 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10930 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10931 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10932 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10933 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10934
10935 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10936 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10937 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10938 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10939
10940 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10941
10942
10943timeout server <timeout>
10944timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10945 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10947 yes | no | yes | yes
10948 Arguments :
10949 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10950 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10951 as explained at the top of this document.
10952
10953 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10954 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10955 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10956 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10957 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10958 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10959 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10960
10961 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10962 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10963 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10964 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10965 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010966 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010967 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010968 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10969 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010970 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10971 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010972
10973 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10974 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10975 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10976 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010977 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010978 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10979
10980 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10981 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10982 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10983
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010984 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010985
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010986
10987timeout server-fin <timeout>
10988 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10990 yes | no | yes | yes
10991 Arguments :
10992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10994 as explained at the top of this document.
10995
10996 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10997 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10998 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10999 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11000 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11001 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11002 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11003 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11004 situations, it should not be needed.
11005
11006 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11007 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11008 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11009
11010 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11011
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011012
11013timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011014 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11016 yes | yes | yes | yes
11017 Arguments :
11018 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11019 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11020 as explained at the top of this document.
11021
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011022 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11023 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11024 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11025 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011026
11027 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11028 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11029 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11030 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011031 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011032
11033 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11034
11035
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011036timeout tunnel <timeout>
11037 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11039 yes | no | yes | yes
11040 Arguments :
11041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11043 as explained at the top of this document.
11044
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011045 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011046 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11047 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11048 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011049 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11050 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011051 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11052 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11053 specified.
11054
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011055 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11056 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11057 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11058 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11059 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11060 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11061 state.
11062
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11065 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11066 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011067 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011068
11069 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11070 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11071 forget about it.
11072
11073 Example :
11074 defaults http
11075 option http-server-close
11076 timeout connect 5s
11077 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011078 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011079 timeout server 30s
11080 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11081
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011082 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011083
11084
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011085transparent (deprecated)
11086 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011088 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011089 Arguments : none
11090
11091 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11092 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11093 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11094 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11095 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11096 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11097 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11098 appropriate server.
11099
11100 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11101
11102 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11103 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11104
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011105 See also: "option transparent"
11106
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011107unique-id-format <string>
11108 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11110 yes | yes | yes | no
11111 Arguments :
11112 <string> is a log-format string.
11113
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011114 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11115 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11116 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11117 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011119 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11120 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11121 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11122 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11123 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11124 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11125 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11126 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011127
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011128 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11129 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011130
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011131 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011132
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011133 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011134
11135 will generate:
11136
11137 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11138
11139 See also: "unique-id-header"
11140
11141unique-id-header <name>
11142 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11144 yes | yes | yes | no
11145 Arguments :
11146 <name> is the name of the header.
11147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011148 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11149 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011151 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011152
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011153 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011154 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11155
11156 will generate:
11157
11158 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11159
11160 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011161
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011162use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011163 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11165 no | yes | yes | no
11166 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011167 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11168 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011169
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011170 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11171 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011172
11173 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11174 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11175 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011176 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011178 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11179 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011180
11181 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11182 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11183 assign the backend.
11184
11185 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11186 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11187 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11188 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11189 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11190 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11191
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011192 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011193 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011194 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11195 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11196 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11197
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011198 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11199 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11200 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11201 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11202 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11203 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11204 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11205 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11206 cannot be forced from the request.
11207
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011208 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011209 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11210 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11211
11212 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11213 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011214
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011215
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011216use-server <server> if <condition>
11217use-server <server> unless <condition>
11218 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11220 no | no | yes | yes
11221 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011222 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011223
11224 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11225
11226 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11227 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11228 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11229
11230 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11231 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11232 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11233 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11234 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11235 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11236 matches will assign the server.
11237
11238 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11239 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11240 with the next rules until one matches.
11241
11242 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11243 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11244 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11245 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11246
11247 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11248 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11249 stripped.
11250
11251 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11252 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11253 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11254 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11255
11256 Example :
11257 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11258 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11259 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11260 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11261 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11262 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011263 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011264 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11265 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011267 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112705. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011271--------------------------
11272
11273The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11274depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11275settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11276written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11277described in this section.
11278
11279
112805.1. Bind options
11281-----------------
11282
11283The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11284as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11285no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11286parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11287while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11288provided immediately after the setting name.
11289
11290The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11291
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011292accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11293 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11294 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11295 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11296 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11297 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11298 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11299 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11300 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11301 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011302 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11303 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11304 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306accept-proxy
11307 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011308 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11309 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011310 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11311 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11312 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11313 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11316 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011317 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11318 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011319
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011320allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011321 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011322 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011323 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011324 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11325 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011326
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011327alpn <protocols>
11328 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11329 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11330 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011331 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011332 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011333 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11334 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11335 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11336 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11337 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11338 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11339 preference, like below :
11340
11341 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011343backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011344 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011345 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11346
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011347curves <curves>
11348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11349 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11350 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11351 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11352 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11353 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11354
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011355ecdhe <named curve>
11356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011357 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11358 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011359
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011360ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11362 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11363 client's certificate.
11364
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011365ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11367 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11368 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11369 error is ignored.
11370
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011371ca-sign-file <cafile>
11372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11373 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11374 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11375 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11376 'generate-certificates' for details.
11377
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011378ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11380 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11381 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11382 'generate-certificates' for details.
11383
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011384ciphers <ciphers>
11385 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11386 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011387 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011388 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011389 information and recommendations see e.g.
11390 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11391 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11392 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11393
11394ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11396 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11397 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11398 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011399 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11400 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011401
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011402crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11404 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11405 to verify client's certificate.
11406
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011407crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11409 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11410 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11411 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11412 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11413 file.
11414
11415 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11416 are loaded.
11417
11418 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011419 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011420 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11421 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11422 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11423 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11425 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011426 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011427
11428 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11429 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11430 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11431 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011432 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11433 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011434
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011435 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011436
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011437 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011438 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011439 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11440 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011441 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11442 clients).
11443
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011444 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11445 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11446 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11447 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11448 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11449 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11450 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11451 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11452 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11453 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11454 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11455 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11456 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11457
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011458 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11459 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11460 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11461 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11462 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11463
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011464 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11465 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11466 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11467 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011468
11469 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11470 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11471 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11472 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11473 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11474 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11475 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11476 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11477 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11478
11479 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11480
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011481 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011482 a cert bundle.
11483
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011485 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11486 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11487 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11488 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11489 provide multi-cert support.
11490
11491 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11492
11493 Filename | CN | SAN
11494 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11495 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011496 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011497 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11498 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11499
11500 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11501 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11502 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11503 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011504 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11505 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11506 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011507
11508 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11509 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11510
11511 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11512 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11513 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11514
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011515crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011517 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011518 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011519 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011520
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011521crt-list <file>
11522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011523 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11524 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011525
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011526 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11527
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011528 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11529 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011530 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011531 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011532
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011533 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11534 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11535 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11536 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11537 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11538 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11539 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11540 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011541
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011542 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011543 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011544 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11545 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11546 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011547
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011548 crt-list file example:
11549 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011550 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011551 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011552 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011553
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011554defer-accept
11555 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11556 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11557 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011559 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11560 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11561 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11562 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11563 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11564 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11565 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11566
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011567expose-fd listeners
11568 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11569 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011570 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11571 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011572 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011573
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011574force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011575 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011576 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011577 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011578 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011579
11580force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011581 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011582 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011583 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011584
11585force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011586 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011587 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011588 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011589
11590force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011591 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011592 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011593 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011594
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011595force-tlsv13
11596 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11597 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011598 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011599
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011600generate-certificates
11601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11602 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11603 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11604 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11605 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11606 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11607 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11608 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11609 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11610 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11611 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11612
11613 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11614 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011616 certificate is used many times.
11617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011618gid <gid>
11619 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11620 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11621 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11622 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11623 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11624
11625group <group>
11626 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11627 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11628 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11629 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11630 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11631
11632id <id>
11633 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11634 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11635 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11636 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11637
11638interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011639 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11640 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11641 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11642 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11643 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11644 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011645 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11646 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11647 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11648 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11649 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11650 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011651
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011652level <level>
11653 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11654 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11655 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011656 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011657 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11658 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11659 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011660 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011661 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011662 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011663 all counters).
11664
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011665severity-output <format>
11666 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11667 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11668 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11669 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11670 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11671 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11672 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11673 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11674 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11675 rfc5424 convention.
11676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011677maxconn <maxconn>
11678 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11679 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11680 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11681 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11682 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11683 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11684 eat all memory.
11685
11686mode <mode>
11687 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11688 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11689 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11690 UNIX sockets.
11691
11692mss <maxseg>
11693 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11694 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11695 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11696 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11697 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11698 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11699 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11700 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11701 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11702 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11703 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11704
11705name <name>
11706 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11707 page.
11708
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011709namespace <name>
11710 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11711 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11712 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11713 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011715nice <nice>
11716 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11717 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11718 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11719 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11720 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11721 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11722 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11723 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11724 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11725 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11726 one for an RDP socket.
11727
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011728no-ca-names
11729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11730 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11731
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011732no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011734 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011735 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011736 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011737 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11738 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011739
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011740no-tls-tickets
11741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11742 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11743 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011744 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11745 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011746
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011747no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011749 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011750 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011751 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011752 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11753 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011754
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011755no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011757 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011758 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011759 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011760 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11761 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011762
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011763no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011765 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011766 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011767 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11769 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011770
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011771no-tlsv13
11772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11773 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11774 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11775 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011776 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11777 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011778
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011779npn <protocols>
11780 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11781 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11782 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011783 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011784 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011785 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11786 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11787 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11788 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11789 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011790
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011791prefer-client-ciphers
11792 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11793 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11794 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011795 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11796 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11797 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011798
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011799process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011800 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011801 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011802 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011803 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11804 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11805 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11806 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011807 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011808 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11809 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11810 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11811 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11812 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011813
11814 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11815
11816 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11817 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11818 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11819 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11820 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11821 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11822 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11823 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011824
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011825proto <name>
11826 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11827 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11828 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11829 in haproxy -vv.
11830 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11831 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011832 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011833 h2" on the bind line.
11834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011835ssl
11836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011837 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11839 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011840 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11841 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011842
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011843ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11844 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11845 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11846 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11847
11848ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11849 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11850 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11851 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11852
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011853strict-sni
11854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11855 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11856 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11857 See the "crt" option for more information.
11858
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011859tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011860 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011861 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11862 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011863 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011864 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11865 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11866 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11867 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11868 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11869 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11870 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11871
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011872tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011873 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011874 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11875 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11876 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11877 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11878 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11879 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11880 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011881 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11882 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11883 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011884
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011885tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11886 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011887 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11888 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11889 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11890 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11891 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11892 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11893 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11894 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11895 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11896 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011897 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11898 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011900transparent
11901 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11902 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11903 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11904 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11905 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11906 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11907 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11908 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11909 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11910 so check for support with your vendor.
11911
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011912v4v6
11913 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11914 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11915 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11916 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011917 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011918
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011919v6only
11920 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11921 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11922 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011923 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11924 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011926uid <uid>
11927 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11928 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11929 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11930 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11931 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11932
11933user <user>
11934 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11935 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11936 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11937 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11938 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11939
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011940verify [none|optional|required]
11941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11942 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11943 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11944 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11945 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011946 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11947 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11948 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11949 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119515.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011952------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011954The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11955which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11956arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11957settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11958after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11959Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11960address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011962 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011963 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011964
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011965Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11966keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011968The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011969
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011970addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011971 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011972 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11973 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11974 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11975 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11976 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011977
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011978agent-check
11979 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011980 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011981 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11982 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11983 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011984
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011985 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011986 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011987 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11988 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11989 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011990
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11992 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11993 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11994 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11995 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011996
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011997 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011998 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011999
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012000 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12001 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12002 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012003
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012004 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12005 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12006 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012007
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012008 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12009 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12010 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12011 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12012 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012013 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012014 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012015
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012016 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12017 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012019 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12020 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12021 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12022 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12023 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12024 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12025 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12026 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12027 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012028
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012029 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12030 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012031 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12032 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12033 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012034 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012035
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012036 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012037 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012038
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012039agent-send <string>
12040 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12041 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12042 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12043 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12044 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12045
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012046agent-inter <delay>
12047 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12048 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12049
12050 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12051 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12052 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12053 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12054 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12055 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12056 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12057 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12058 of backends use the same servers.
12059
12060 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12061
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012062agent-addr <addr>
12063 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12064
12065 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12066 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12067 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12068 hostname, it will be resolved.
12069
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070agent-port <port>
12071 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12072
12073 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12074
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012075allow-0rtt
12076 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012077 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12078 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012079
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012080alpn <protocols>
12081 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12082 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12083 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012084 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012085 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12086 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12087 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12088 now obsolete NPN extension.
12089 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12090 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12091
12092 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094backup
12095 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12096 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12097 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12098 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012099 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12100 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012101
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012102ca-file <cafile>
12103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12104 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12105 server's certificate.
12106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107check
12108 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012109 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12110 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12111 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12112 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12113 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12114 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12115 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012116 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12117 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012118 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12119 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012120
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012121check-send-proxy
12122 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12123 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12124 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12125 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12126 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12127 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12128 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12129
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012130check-alpn <protocols>
12131 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12132 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12133 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12134
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012135check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012136 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012137 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12138 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012139
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012140check-ssl
12141 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12142 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12143 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12144 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012145 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012146 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12147 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012148 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12150 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012151
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012152check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012153 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012154 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12155 for normal traffic.
12156
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012157ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12159 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12160 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012161 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12162 information and recommendations see e.g.
12163 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12164 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12165 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012166
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012167ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12169 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12170 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12171 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012172 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12173 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12174 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176cookie <value>
12177 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12178 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12179 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12180 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12181 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12182 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12183 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12184
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012185crl-file <crlfile>
12186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12187 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12188 to verify server's certificate.
12189
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012190crt <cert>
12191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12192 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12193 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12194 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12195 certificate request.
12196
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012197disabled
12198 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12199 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12200 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12201 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12202 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012203 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012204
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012205enabled
12206 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12207 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12208 default value.
12209 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12210 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012212error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012213 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12214 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12215 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012217 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012219fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012220 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12221 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12222 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12223
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012224force-sslv3
12225 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12226 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012227 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012228 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012229
12230force-tlsv10
12231 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012232 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012234
12235force-tlsv11
12236 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012237 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012238 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012239
12240force-tlsv12
12241 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012242 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012243 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012244
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012245force-tlsv13
12246 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12247 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012248 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012250id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012251 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12252 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12253 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012254
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012255init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12256 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12257 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012258 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012259 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12260 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12261 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12262 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12263 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12264 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12265 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12266 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12267 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012269 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12270 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12271 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12272 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12273 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12274 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012275 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012276
12277 Example:
12278 defaults
12279 # never fail on address resolution
12280 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012282inter <delay>
12283fastinter <delay>
12284downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012285 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12286 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12287 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12288 between checks depending on the server state :
12289
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012290 Server state | Interval used
12291 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12292 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12293 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12294 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12295 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12296 or yet unchecked. |
12297 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12298 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12299 | "inter" otherwise.
12300 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012302 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12303 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12304 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12305 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012306 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12307 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12308 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12309 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12310 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012312maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12314 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012315 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12316 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12318 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12319 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12320 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12321
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012322 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12323 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12324 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12325 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12326 than 50 concurrent requests.
12327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012328maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012329 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12330 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12331 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12332 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12333 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12334 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12335 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12336
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012337max-reuse <count>
12338 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12339 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12340 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12341 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12342 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12343 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12344 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12345 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012347minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12349 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12350 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12351 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12352 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12353 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012354 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012355 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012356
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012357namespace <name>
12358 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12359 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12360 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12361 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12362
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012363no-agent-check
12364 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12365 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12366 default value.
12367 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12368 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12369
12370no-backup
12371 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12372 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12373 default value.
12374 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12375 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12376
12377no-check
12378 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12379 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12380 default value.
12381 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12382 "default-server" "check" setting.
12383
12384no-check-ssl
12385 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12386 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12387 default value.
12388 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12389 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12390
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012391no-send-proxy
12392 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12393 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12394 default value.
12395 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12396 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12397
12398no-send-proxy-v2
12399 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12400 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12401 default value.
12402 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12403 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12404
12405no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12408 default value.
12409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12410 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12411
12412no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12413 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12414 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12415 default value.
12416 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12417 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12418
12419no-ssl
12420 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12421 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12422 default value.
12423 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12424 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12425
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012426no-ssl-reuse
12427 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12428 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12429 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12430 and for paranoid users.
12431
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012432no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012433 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12434 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012435 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012436
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012437 Supported in default-server: No
12438
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012439no-tls-tickets
12440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12441 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12442 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012443 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12444 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012445 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012446
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012447no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012448 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012449 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12450 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012451 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12452 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012453 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012454
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012455 Supported in default-server: No
12456
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012457no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012458 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012459 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12460 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012461 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12462 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012463 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012464
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012465 Supported in default-server: No
12466
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012467no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012468 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012469 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12470 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012471 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12472 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012473 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012474
12475 Supported in default-server: No
12476
12477no-tlsv13
12478 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12479 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12480 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12481 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12482 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012483 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012484
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012485 Supported in default-server: No
12486
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012487no-verifyhost
12488 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12489 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12490 default value.
12491 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12492 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012493
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012494no-tfo
12495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12497 default value.
12498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12499 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12500
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012501non-stick
12502 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12503 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12504 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12505
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012506npn <protocols>
12507 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12508 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12509 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012510 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012511 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12512 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12513 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012515observe <mode>
12516 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12517 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12518 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12519 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12520 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12521 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012522 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012523
12524 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012526on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012527 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12528 Currently, four modes are available:
12529 - fastinter: force fastinter
12530 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12531 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12532 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12533 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12534
12535 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12536
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012537on-marked-down <action>
12538 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12539 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012540 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12541 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12542 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12543 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12544 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12545 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12546 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12547 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012548
12549 Actions are disabled by default
12550
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012551on-marked-up <action>
12552 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12553 Currently one action is available:
12554 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12555 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12556 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12557 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012558 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12559 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012560 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12561 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12562
12563 Actions are disabled by default
12564
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012565pool-max-conn <max>
12566 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12567 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12568 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12569 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12570 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12571 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12572
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012573pool-purge-delay <delay>
12574 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012575 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012576 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012578port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12580 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12581 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12582 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12583 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12584 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12585
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012586proto <name>
12587
12588 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12589 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12590 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12591 reported in haproxy -vv.
12592 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12593 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012595redir <prefix>
12596 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12597 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12598 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12599 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12600 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12601 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12602 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12603 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012604 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012605 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012606 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12607 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12608 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12609 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12610
12611 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012613rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012614 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12615 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12616 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12617
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012618resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12619 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12620 server.
12621
12622 Available options:
12623
12624 * allow-dup-ip
12625 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12626 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12627 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12628 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12629 For such case, simply enable this option.
12630 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12631
12632 * prevent-dup-ip
12633 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12634 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12635 same fqdn.
12636 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12637
12638 Example:
12639 backend b_myapp
12640 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12641 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12642 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12643
12644 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12645 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12646 it
12647 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12648 different address
12649
12650 Default value: not set
12651
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012652resolve-prefer <family>
12653 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12654 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12655 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12656 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12657
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012658 Default value: ipv6
12659
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012660 Example:
12661
12662 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012663
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012664resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012665 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012666 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012667 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12669 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012670 configured network, another address is selected.
12671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012672 Example:
12673
12674 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012675
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012676resolvers <id>
12677 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12678 hostname.
12679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012680 Example:
12681
12682 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012684 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012685
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012686send-proxy
12687 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12688 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12689 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12690 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012691 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12692 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12693 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12694 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12695 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12696 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12697 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12698 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12699 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12700 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012701 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12702 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012703
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012704send-proxy-v2
12705 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12706 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12707 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12708 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012709 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12710 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12711 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12712 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012713
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012714proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12715 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12716 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012717 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12718 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012719 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12720 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012721 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012722
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012723send-proxy-v2-ssl
12724 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12725 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12726 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12727 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12728 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12729 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12730 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012731 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12732 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012733
12734send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12735 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12736 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12737 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12738 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12739 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12740 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12741 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12742 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12744 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012746slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012747 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12748 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12749 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12750 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12751 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12752 parameters :
12753
12754 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12755 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12756
12757 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12758 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12759 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12760 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12761
12762 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12763 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12764 seen as failed.
12765
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012766sni <expression>
12767 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12768 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12769 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12770 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012771 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12772 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012773 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012774 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12775 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012776
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012777source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012778source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012779source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012780 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12781 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12782 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12783 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12784
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012785 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12786 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12787 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12788 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12789 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12790 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12791 server.
12792
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012793 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12794 specifying the source address without port(s).
12795
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012796ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012797 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12798 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12799 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12800 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12801 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12802 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012803 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12804 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012805
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012806ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12807 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12808 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12809 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12810
12811ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12812 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12813 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12814 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12815
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012816ssl-reuse
12817 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12818 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12819 default value.
12820 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12821 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12822
12823stick
12824 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12825 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12826 default value.
12827 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12828 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012829
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012830socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012831 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012832 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12833 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12834
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012835tcp-ut <delay>
12836 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12837 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12838 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012840 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12841 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12842 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12843 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12844 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12845 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12846 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12847 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12848 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12849
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012850tfo
12851 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12852 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12853 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12854 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12855 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012856 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012858track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012859 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12860 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12861 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12862 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012863 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12864
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012865tls-tickets
12866 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12867 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12868 default value.
12869 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12870 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012871
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012872verify [none|required]
12873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012874 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012875 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12876 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012877 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012878 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12879 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12880 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12881 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12882 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12883 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12884 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12885 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012886
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012887verifyhost <hostname>
12888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012889 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12890 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12891 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12892 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12893 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12894 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12895 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12896 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012898weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012899 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12900 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12901 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012902 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12903 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12904 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12905 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12906 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12907 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012908
12909
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129105.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12911-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012912
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012913HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12914using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12915configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012916This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12917can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12918workload.
12919This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12920resolution at run time.
12921Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12922carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12923
12924
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129255.3.1. Global overview
12926----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012927
12928As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12929different steps of the process life:
12930
12931 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12932 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12933 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12934
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012935 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12936 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012937
12938A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12939 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12940 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12941 resolution to know this new IP.
12942
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012943When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012944HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012945SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12946from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12947will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12948will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012949
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012950A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012951 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012952 first valid response.
12953
12954 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12955 servers return an error.
12956
12957
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129585.3.2. The resolvers section
12959----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012960
12961This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012962HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12963contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012964
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012965When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12966uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12967is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12968answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12969
12970When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012971used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012972
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012973 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12974 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12975 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012976
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012977 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12978 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012979
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012980 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12981 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12982 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012983
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012984For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12985following scenarios are possible:
12986
12987 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12988 ignored
12989
12990 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12991 applied
12992
12993 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12994 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12995
12996 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12997 retries the query with a new type
12998
12999 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13000 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013001
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013002As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13003a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013004<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013005
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013006
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013007resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013008 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013009
13010A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13011
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013012accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013013 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013014 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013015 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13016 by RFC 6891)
13017
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013018 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13019
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013020nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13021 DNS server description:
13022 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13023 <ip> : IP address of the server
13024 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13025
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013026parse-resolv-conf
13027 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13028 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13029 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13030
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013031hold <status> <period>
13032 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13033 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013034 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013035 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013036 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13037 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13038 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13039
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013040 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013041
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013042resolve_retries <nb>
13043 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13044 giving up.
13045 Default value: 3
13046
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013047 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13048 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13049 type.
13050
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013051timeout <event> <time>
13052 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13053 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13054 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013055 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13056 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013057 Default value: 1s
13058 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013059 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013060 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013061 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13062 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13063
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013064 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013065
13066 resolvers mydns
13067 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13068 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013069 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013070 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013071 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013072 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013073 hold other 30s
13074 hold refused 30s
13075 hold nx 30s
13076 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013077 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013078 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013079
13080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130816. HTTP header manipulation
13082---------------------------
13083
13084In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13085response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13086request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13087which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013088against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013089
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013090If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13091to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13092but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13093HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13094stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13095because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13096a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13097still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013099This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13100in section 4.2 :
13101
13102 - reqadd <string>
13103 - reqallow <search>
13104 - reqiallow <search>
13105 - reqdel <search>
13106 - reqidel <search>
13107 - reqdeny <search>
13108 - reqideny <search>
13109 - reqpass <search>
13110 - reqipass <search>
13111 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13112 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13113 - reqtarpit <search>
13114 - reqitarpit <search>
13115 - rspadd <string>
13116 - rspdel <search>
13117 - rspidel <search>
13118 - rspdeny <search>
13119 - rspideny <search>
13120 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13121 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13122
13123With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13124is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13125parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13126prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13127Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13128
13129 \t for a tab
13130 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13131 \n for a new line (LF)
13132 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13133 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13134 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13135 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13136 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13137
13138The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13139portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13140above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13141regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
131429 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13143is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13144
13145The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13146after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13147
13148Notes related to these keywords :
13149---------------------------------
13150 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13151 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13152 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13153
13154 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13155 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13156 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13157
13158 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13159 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13160 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13161 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13162 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13163
13164 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13165 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13166 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13167 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13168 useless headers before adding new ones.
13169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013170 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013171 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13172
13173 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13174 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13175 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13176
13177 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13178 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013179 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013180
13181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131827. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13183----------------------------------
13184
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13187The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13188these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13189but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13190data called patterns.
13191
13192
131937.1. ACL basics
13194---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013195
13196The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13197content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13198from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13199simple :
13200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013202 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13204 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13207adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013208
13209In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013212
13213This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13214Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13215and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013216an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13217conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13218as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13219are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013220
13221ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13222'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13223which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13224
13225There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13226performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13229specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13230this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013231methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13232ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013233
13234Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13235 - boolean
13236 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13237 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13238 - string
13239 - data block
13240
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013241Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13242converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13243would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13244The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13245which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13246
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013247Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13248keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13249fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13250which are summarized in the table below :
13251
13252 +---------------------+-----------------+
13253 | Sample or converter | Default |
13254 | output type | matching method |
13255 +---------------------+-----------------+
13256 | boolean | bool |
13257 +---------------------+-----------------+
13258 | integer | int |
13259 +---------------------+-----------------+
13260 | ip | ip |
13261 +---------------------+-----------------+
13262 | string | str |
13263 +---------------------+-----------------+
13264 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13265 +---------------------+-----------------+
13266
13267Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13268matching method, see below.
13269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13271 - boolean
13272 - integer or integer range
13273 - IP address / network
13274 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13275 - regular expression
13276 - hex block
13277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013278The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13279
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013280 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13281 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013283 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013284 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013285 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013286 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13289read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13290if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13291lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13292will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13293beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13294a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13295lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13296exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13297
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013298The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13299parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13300ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13301a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13302check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13303
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013304The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13305socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13306file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13309loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13310
13311 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13312
13313In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13314the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13315case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13316as well.
13317
13318The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13319sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13320do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13321methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13322is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013323obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013324followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13325default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13326that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13327string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13328
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013329The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13330By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13331string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13332resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13333server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013334waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013335flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13336function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13339sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13340be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013341
13342 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13343 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13345 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13346 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13347 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013348
13349 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13350 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013352
13353 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013355
13356 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013359 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013360 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13361
13362 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13363 binary or string samples.
13364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13366 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13369 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13370 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13373 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13376 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13379 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13382 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013383 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013385 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13386 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13387 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013388
13389For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13390request, it is possible to do :
13391
13392 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13393
13394In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13395buffer, one would use the following acl :
13396
13397 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13398
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013399On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13400possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13401
13402 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13405criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13406method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13407to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13408criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13409the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013412the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13413For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13416 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13417 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13418 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013419
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013420
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013421The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13422types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13423combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13424brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13425default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 +-------------------------------------------------+
13428 | Input sample type |
13429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013430 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13432 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013434 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013436 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013438 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013440 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013442 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013444 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013446 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013448 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013450 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013452 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013454 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13456 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13457 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013458
13459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134607.1.1. Matching booleans
13461------------------------
13462
13463In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13464Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13465When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13466that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13467
13468Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13469return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13470"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134737.1.2. Matching integers
13474------------------------
13475
13476Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13477enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13478to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13479
13480Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13481matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13482lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013483
13484For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13485unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13486representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13487
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013488As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13489two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13490instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13491ranges and operators.
13492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013493For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013494operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13495Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13496of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013498Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013499
13500 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13501 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13502 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13503 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13504 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013506For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013507
13508 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13509
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013510This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13511
13512 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13513
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135157.1.3. Matching strings
13516-----------------------
13517
13518String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13519different forms :
13520
13521 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013522 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523
13524 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013525 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526
13527 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13528 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13529
13530 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13531 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13532
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013533 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13535 matches.
13536
13537 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13538 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13539 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013540
13541String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13542exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13543characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13544string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13545to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013546before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013547
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013548Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13549(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13550Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13551
13552Example:
13553 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13554 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135577.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13558---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013559
13560Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13561they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13562possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13563passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13564the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013565the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13566match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013567
13568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135697.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13570-------------------------------------
13571
13572It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13573not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13574a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13575to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13576digits may be used upper or lower case.
13577
13578Example :
13579 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13580 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13581
13582
135837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13584---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013585
13586IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13587netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13588within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013589host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013590difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13591at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13592does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13593parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013594
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013595The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13596abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13597
13598 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13599 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13600 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13601 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13602 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13603 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13604 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13605 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13606
13607Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13608192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13609
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013610IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13611Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13612trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13613IPv6 patterns.
13614
13615HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13616following situations :
13617 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13618 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13619 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13620 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13621 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13622 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13623 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13624 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13625 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13626 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628
136297.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13630----------------------------------
13631
13632Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13633combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13634
13635 - AND (implicit)
13636 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13637 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013641 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013643Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13644indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13647"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13648requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13649is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13650
13651 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013652 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13653 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13654 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013655
13656To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13657and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13658
13659 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13660 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13661 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13662 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13663
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013664 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013665 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13666 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13667 use_backend www if host_www
13668
13669It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13670expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13671be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13672the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13673
13674 The following rule :
13675
13676 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013677 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013678
13679 Can also be written that way :
13680
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013681 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682
13683It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13684to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13685simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13686sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13687good use is the following :
13688
13689 With named ACLs :
13690
13691 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13692 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13693 monitor fail if site_dead
13694
13695 With anonymous ACLs :
13696
13697 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13698
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013699See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13700keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013701
13702
137037.3. Fetching samples
13704---------------------
13705
13706Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13707against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13708sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13709ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13710of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13711available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13712
13713This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13714Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13715compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13716deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13717
13718The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13719matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13720method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13721indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13722
13723As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13724when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13725mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13726the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13727ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13728
13729Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13730multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13731when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013732incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13733are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13735all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13736
13737Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13738 - name
13739 - name(arg1)
13740 - name(arg1,arg2)
13741
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013742
137437.3.1. Converters
13744-----------------
13745
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013746Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13747of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13748is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13749was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013751unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13752
13753These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13754sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13755the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013756support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013757
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013758A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13759support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13760supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13761(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13762bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013764The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013765
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001376651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13767 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13768 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13769 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13770 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13771 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13772
13773 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13775 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013776 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13777 frontend http-in
13778 bind *:8081
13779 default_backend servers
13780 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13781 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13782
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013783add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013784 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013785 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013786 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13787 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013788 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013789 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13790 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13791 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13792 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013793 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013794 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013795
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013796aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13797 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13798 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13799 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13800 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13801 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13802 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13803
13804 Example:
13805 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13806 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13807
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013808and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013809 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013810 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013811 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13812 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013813 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13815 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13816 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13817 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013818 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013819 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013820
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013821b64dec
13822 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13823 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13824
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013825base64
13826 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013827 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013828 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13829
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013830bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013831 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013832 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013833 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013834 presence of a flag).
13835
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013836bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13837 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13838 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013839 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013840
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013841concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13842 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13843 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13844 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13845 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13846 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13847 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13848 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13849 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13850 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13851 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013852 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013853 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013854 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013855
13856 Example:
13857 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13858 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13859 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13860 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13861
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013862cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013863 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13864 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013865
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013866crc32([<avalanche>])
13867 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13868 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13869 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13870 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13871 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13872 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13873 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13874 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13875 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13876 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013877 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13878
13879crc32c([<avalanche>])
13880 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13881 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13882 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13883 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13884 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13885 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13886 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13887 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013888
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013889da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013890 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13891 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13892 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13893 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013894 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013895 configuration language.
13896
13897 Example:
13898 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013899 bind *:8881
13900 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013901 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013902
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013903debug
13904 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13905 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13906 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13907
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013908div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013909 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13910 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013911 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013912 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13913 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13916 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13917 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13918 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013920 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013921
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013922djb2([<avalanche>])
13923 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13924 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13925 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13926 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13927 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13928 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13929 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013930 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13931 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013932
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013933even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013934 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013935 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13936
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013937field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13938 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13939 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13940 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13941 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13942 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13943 fields.
13944
13945 Example :
13946 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13947 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13948 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13949 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13950 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013951
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013952hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013953 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013954 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013956 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013957
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013958hex2i
13959 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013960 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013962http_date([<offset>])
13963 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13964 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13965 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13966 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13967 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13968 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013970in_table(<table>)
13971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13973 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013975 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13976
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013977ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13978 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013979 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013980 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13981 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13982 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13983 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13984 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013985
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013986json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013987 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013988 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013989 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013990 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13991 of errors:
13992 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13993 bytes, ...)
13994 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13995 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13996
13997 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13998 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13999 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14000 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14001 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14002 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014003 - "ascii" : never fails;
14004 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14005 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014006 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014008 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14009 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14010
14011 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014013
14014 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014015 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014016 capture request header user-agent len 150
14017 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014018
14019 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14020 GET / HTTP/1.0
14021 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14022
14023 Output log:
14024 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14025
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014026language(<value>[,<default>])
14027 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14028 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14029 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14030 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14031 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14032 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14033 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14034 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14035 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014036 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014037 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14038 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014040 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014042 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14043 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014044
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014045 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14046 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14047 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14048 use_backend spanish if es
14049 use_backend french if fr
14050 use_backend english if en
14051 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014052
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014053length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014054 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14055 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14056 type. The result is of type integer.
14057
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014058lower
14059 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14060 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14061 type. The result is of type string.
14062
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014063ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14064 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14065 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14066 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14067 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14068 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14069 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14070
14071 Example :
14072
14073 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014074 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014075 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14076
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014077map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14078map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14079map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14080 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14081 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14082 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14083 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14084 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14085 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14086 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14087 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014088
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014089 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14090 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14091 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014092
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014093 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014094 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014096 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14098 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014100 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014102 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14103 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14104 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14105 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14106 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14108 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014110 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14111 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14112 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014113 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14114 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14115 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14116 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14117 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014118
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014119 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14120 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14121 the corresponding match text.
14122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014123 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14124 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14125 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14126 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14127 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014128
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014129 Example :
14130
14131 # this is a comment and is ignored
14132 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14133 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14134 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14135 | | | `---------- value
14136 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14137 | `---------------------------- key
14138 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14139
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014140mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014141 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14142 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014143 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014144 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014145 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14148 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014150 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014151 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014152
14153mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014154 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014155 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14156 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014157 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014158 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014159 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014160 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14161 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14162 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14163 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014164 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014165 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014166
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014167nbsrv
14168 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14169 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14170 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14171 map lookup.
14172
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014173neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014174 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14175 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14176 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14177 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014178
14179not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014180 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014181 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014182 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014183 absence of a flag).
14184
14185odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014186 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014187 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14188
14189or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014190 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014191 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014192 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14193 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014194 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014195 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14196 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14197 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014199 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014200 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014201
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014202protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14203 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14204 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14205 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14206 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14207 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14208 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14209 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14210 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14211 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14212 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14213 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14214
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014215regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014216 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14217 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14218 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14219 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14220 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14221 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14222 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14223 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14224 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14225 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014226 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14227 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14228 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14229 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014230
14231 Example :
14232
14233 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14234 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14235 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14236 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14237
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014238capture-req(<id>)
14239 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14240 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14241
14242 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014243 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14244 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014245
14246capture-res(<id>)
14247 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14248 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14249
14250 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014251 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14252 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014253
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014254sdbm([<avalanche>])
14255 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14256 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14257 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14258 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14259 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14260 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14261 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014262 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14263 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014264
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014265set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14267 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14268 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014269 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014270 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14271 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014272 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014273 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14274 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014276 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014277
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014278sha1
14279 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14280 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14281
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014282strcmp(<var>)
14283 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14284 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14285 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14286 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14287 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14288 shorter).
14289
14290 Example :
14291
14292 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14293 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14294 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14295
14296
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014297sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014298 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14299 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014300 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014301 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14302 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014306 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014310 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014311
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014312table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14313 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14314 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14315 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14316 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14317 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14318 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14319
14320
14321table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14322 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14323 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14324 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14325 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14326 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14327 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14328
14329table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014332 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014333 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14334 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14335
14336table_conn_cur(<table>)
14337 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14338 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14339 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14340 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14341 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14342
14343table_conn_rate(<table>)
14344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14346 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14347 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14348 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14349
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014350table_gpt0(<table>)
14351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14354 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14355 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14356
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014357table_gpc0(<table>)
14358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14361 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14362 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14363
14364table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14368 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14369 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14370 sample fetch keyword.
14371
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014372table_gpc1(<table>)
14373 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14374 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14375 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14376 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14377 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14378
14379table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14383 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14384 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14385 sample fetch keyword.
14386
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014387table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014391 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14392 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14393
14394table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14395 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14396 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14397 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14398 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14399 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14400 keyword.
14401
14402table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014406 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14407 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14408
14409table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14412 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14413 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14414 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14415 keyword.
14416
14417table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014421 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14422 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14423 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14424 keyword.
14425
14426table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014430 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14431 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14432 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14433 keyword.
14434
14435table_server_id(<table>)
14436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14439 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14440 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14441 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14442
14443table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014446 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014447 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14448 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14449 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14450 keyword.
14451
14452table_sess_rate(<table>)
14453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14456 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14457 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14458 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14459 keyword.
14460
14461table_trackers(<table>)
14462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14464 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14465 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14466 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14467 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14468 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14469 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14470 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14471 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14472
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014473upper
14474 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14475 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14476 type. The result is of type string.
14477
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014478url_dec
14479 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14480 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14481
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014482ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014483 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014484 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14485 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14486 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014487 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14488 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14489 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14490 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014491 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014492 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14493 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014494
14495 Example:
14496 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14497 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14498
14499 message Point {
14500 int32 latitude = 1;
14501 int32 longitude = 2;
14502 }
14503
14504 message PPoint {
14505 Point point = 59;
14506 }
14507
14508 message Rectangle {
14509 // One corner of the rectangle.
14510 PPoint lo = 48;
14511 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14512 PPoint hi = 49;
14513 }
14514
14515 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14516 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14517 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14518
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014519 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14520 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014521 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014522 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14523
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014524 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014525
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014526 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014527
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014528 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014529 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14530 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14531
14532 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14533 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14534 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14535
14536 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14537 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14538 interpret the previous binary sample.
14539
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014540
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014541unset-var(<var name>)
14542 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14543 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14544 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14547 response),
14548 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14549 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14550 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14551 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14552
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014553utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14554 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14555 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14556 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14557 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14558 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14559 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14560
14561 Example :
14562
14563 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014564 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014565 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14566
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014567word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14568 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14569 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14570 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14571 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14572 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14573
14574 Example :
14575 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14576 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14577 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14578 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14579 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014580
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014581wt6([<avalanche>])
14582 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14583 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14584 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14585 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14586 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14587 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14588 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014589 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14590 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014591
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014592xor(<value>)
14593 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014594 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014595 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014596 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014597 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014598 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14599 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014600 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014601 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14602 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014603 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014604 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014605
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014606xxh32([<seed>])
14607 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14608 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14609 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14610 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14611 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14612 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14613 as cryptographically secure.
14614
14615xxh64([<seed>])
14616 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14617 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14618 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14619 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14620 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14621 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14622 as cryptographically secure.
14623
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146257.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626--------------------------------------------
14627
14628A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14629not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14630"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14631The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14632
14633always_false : boolean
14634 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14635 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14636
14637always_true : boolean
14638 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14639 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14640
14641avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014642 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014643 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14644 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14645 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14646 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14647 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14648 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14649 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14650 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14651 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14652 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14653 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14654 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14655 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014658 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14659 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14660 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14661 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014662 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14663
14664be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14666 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14667 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14668 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14669 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014670 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14671 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014672
14673 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14674 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14675 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14678 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14679 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14680 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014681 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014682 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14683 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014684
14685 Example :
14686 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14687 backend dynamic
14688 mode http
14689 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14690 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014692bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014693 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14694 of the string.
14695
14696bool(<bool>) : bool
14697 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14698 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014702 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14704 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014705
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014706 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014707 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014708 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14709
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014710 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14711 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014712
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014713 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014714 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014715 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014716 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014717 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014719 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014720
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014721 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14722 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014724 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014725
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014726cpu_calls : integer
14727 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14728 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14729 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14730 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14731 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14732 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14733
14734cpu_ns_avg : integer
14735 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14736 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14737 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14738 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14739 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14740 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14741 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14742 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14743 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14744 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14745 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14746
14747cpu_ns_tot : integer
14748 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14749 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14750 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14751 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14752 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14753 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14754 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14755 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14756 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14757 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14758 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14759 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14760 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14761
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014762date([<offset>]) : integer
14763 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14764 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14765 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14766 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014767 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14768
14769 Example :
14770
14771 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14772 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014773
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014774date_us : integer
14775 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14776 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14777 from the same timeval structure.
14778
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014779distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14780 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14781 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14782 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14783 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14784 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14785 list of supported tokens.
14786
14787distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14788 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14789 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14790 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14791 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14792 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14793 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14794 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14795 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14796 supported tokens.
14797
14798 Example :
14799 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14800 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14801 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14802 # send large files to the big farm
14803 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14804
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014805env(<name>) : string
14806 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14807 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14808 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14809 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14810 certain way.
14811
14812 Examples :
14813 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14814 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14815
14816 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14817 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14820 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014821 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14822 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14824 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014825 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14827 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014828
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014829fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14830 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14831 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14832 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14835 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14836 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14837 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14838 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14839 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14840 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14841 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14842 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014843
14844 Example :
14845 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14846 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14847 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14848 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14849 frontend mail
14850 bind :25
14851 mode tcp
14852 maxconn 100
14853 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14854 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14855 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14856 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014857
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014858hostname : string
14859 Returns the system hostname.
14860
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014861int(<integer>) : signed integer
14862 Returns a signed integer.
14863
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014864ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14865 Returns an ipv4.
14866
14867ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14868 Returns an ipv6.
14869
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014870lat_ns_avg : integer
14871 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14872 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14873 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14874 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14875 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14876 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14877 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14878 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14879 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14880 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14881 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14882 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14883 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14884 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14885
14886lat_ns_tot : integer
14887 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14888 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14889 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14890 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14891 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14892 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14893 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14894 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14895 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14896 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14897 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14898 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14899 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14900 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14901 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14902 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14903 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14904 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14905 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14906
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014907meth(<method>) : method
14908 Returns a method.
14909
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014910nbproc : integer
14911 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14912 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14913 and debugging purposes.
14914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14917 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14918 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014919 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14920 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14921 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014922
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014923prio_class : integer
14924 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14925 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14926 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14927
14928prio_offset : integer
14929 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14930 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14931 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14932 set-priority-offset".
14933
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014934proc : integer
14935 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14936 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14937 debugging purposes.
14938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014940 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14941 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14942 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14944 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14945 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14946 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14947 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14948
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014949rand([<range>]) : integer
14950 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14951 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14952 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14953 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14954 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14955
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014956uuid([<version>]) : string
14957 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14958 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14959 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14963 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14964 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14965 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14966 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014967 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14968 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14969
14970srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14971 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14972 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14973 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14974 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14975 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14976 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14977 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14978
14979 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14980 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981
14982srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14983 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14984 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14985 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014986 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14988 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14989 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14990
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014991srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14993 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14994 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14995 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14996 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14997 fetch methods.
14998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15000 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15001 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015002 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15004 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015005 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015006 overloading servers).
15007
15008 Example :
15009 # Redirect to a separate back
15010 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15011 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15012 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15013
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015014stopping : boolean
15015 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15016 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15017 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15018
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015019str(<string>) : string
15020 Returns a string.
15021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15023 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15024 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15025
15026table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15027 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15028 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15029 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15030
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015031thread : integer
15032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15033 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15034 and debugging purposes.
15035
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015036var(<var-name>) : undefined
15037 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015038 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15039 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015040 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015041 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15042 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015043 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015044 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15045 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015047 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150497.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050----------------------------------
15051
15052The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15053closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15054methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15055sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15056TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015057the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15058counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015059"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15060used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15061can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15062Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15063table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15064tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15065currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015067bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015068 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15069 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15070 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072be_id : integer
15073 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15074 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15075
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015076be_name : string
15077 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15078 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080dst : ip
15081 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15082 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15083 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15084 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015085 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15086 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15087 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15088 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15089 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15090 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091
15092dst_conn : integer
15093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15094 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15095 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15096 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15097 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15098 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15099 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15100 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015101
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015102dst_is_local : boolean
15103 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15104 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15105 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15106 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015107 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015108 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15109 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15110 it only once per connection.
15111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112dst_port : integer
15113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15114 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15115 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15116 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15117 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15118 an HTTP header.
15119
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015120fc_http_major : integer
15121 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15122 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15123 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15124
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015125fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15126 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15127 header.
15128
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015129fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15130 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15131 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15132 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15133 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15134 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15135 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15136
15137fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15138 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15139 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15140 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15141 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15142 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15143 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15144
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015145fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015146 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15147 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15148 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15149 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15150
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015151fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015152 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15153 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15154 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15155 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15156
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015157fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015158 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15159 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15160 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15161 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15162
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015163fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015164 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15165 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15166 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15167 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15168
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015169fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015170 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15171 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15172 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15173 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15174
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015175fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015176 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15177 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15178 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15179 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15180
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015181fe_defbe : string
15182 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15183 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015185fe_id : integer
15186 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015187 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015188 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15189
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015190fe_name : string
15191 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15192 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15193 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15194
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015195sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015196sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15197sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15198sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015199 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15200 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15201 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15202
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015203sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015204sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15205sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15206sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015207 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15208 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15209 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015211sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015212sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15213sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15214sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015215 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15216 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015217 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15218 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15219 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015220
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015221 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015222 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15223 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015224 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15225 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15226 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015227 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15228 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15229
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015230sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15231sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15232sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15233sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15234 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15235 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15236 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15237 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15238 when a first ACL was verified.
15239
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015240sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015241sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15242sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15243sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015245 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15246
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015247sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015248sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15249sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15250sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015251 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15252 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15253 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15254
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015255sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015256sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15257sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15258sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015259 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15260 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15261 See also src_conn_rate.
15262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015263sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015264sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15265sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15266sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015267 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015268 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015269
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015270sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15271sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15272sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15273sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15274 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15275 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15276
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015277sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15278sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15279sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15280sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15281 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15282 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15283
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015284sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015285sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15286sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15287sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015288 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15289 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15290 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015291 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15292 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15293 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015294
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015295sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15296sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15297sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15298sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15299 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15300 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15301 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15302 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15303 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15304 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15305
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015306sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015307sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15308sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15309sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015310 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015311 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15312 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15313
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015314sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015315sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15316sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15317sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015318 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15319 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15320 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15321 src_http_err_rate.
15322
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015323sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015324sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15325sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15326sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015327 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015328 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15329 src_http_req_cnt.
15330
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015331sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015332sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15333sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15334sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015335 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15336 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15337 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15338 src_http_req_rate.
15339
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015340sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015341sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15342sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15343sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015344 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015345 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15346 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15347 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15348 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015349
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015350 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015351 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15352 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015353 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15354
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015355sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15356sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15357sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15358sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15359 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15360 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15361 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15362 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15363 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015365sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015366sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15367sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15368sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015369 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15370 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15371 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015372
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015373sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015374sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15375sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15376sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015377 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15378 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15379 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015380
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015381sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015382sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15383sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15384sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015385 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015386 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15387 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15388 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015389 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015390 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015392sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015393sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015396 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15397 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15398 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15399 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15400 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015401 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015403sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015404sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15405sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15406sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015407 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15408 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15409 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15410
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015411sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015412sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15413sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15414sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015415 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15416 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015417 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015418 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15419 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15421 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15422 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424so_id : integer
15425 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15426 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15427 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15432 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15433 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015434 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15435 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15436 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015437 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15438 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15439 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15440 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15441 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15442 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15443 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015444
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015445 Example:
15446 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15447 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15450 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15451 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15452 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015453 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15456 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15457 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015458 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015459 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15462 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15463 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15464 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15465 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15466 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15467 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015468
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015469 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015470 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15471 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15472 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15473 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015474 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015475 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15476 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15477
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015478src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15479 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15480 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15481 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15482 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15483 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15484 was verified.
15485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015487 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015489 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015490 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015493 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15495 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015496 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15499 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15500 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15501 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015502 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015505 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015507 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015508 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015509
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015510src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15511 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15512 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15513 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15514 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15515
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015516src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15517 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15518 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15519 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15520 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015523 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015525 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15526 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015527 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15528 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15529 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015530
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015531src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15532 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15533 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15534 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15535 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15536 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15537 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15538 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015541 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015543 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015544 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15548 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15549 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15550 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15551 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015552 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015555 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15557 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015558 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15561 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15562 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15563 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015565 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15568 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15569 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15570 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015571 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15573 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015574
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015575 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015576 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015577 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015578 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015579
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015580src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15581 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15582 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15583 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15584 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15585 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15586 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15587
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015588src_is_local : boolean
15589 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15590 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15591 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15592 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015593 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015594 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15595 once per connection.
15596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015598 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15599 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15600 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15601 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15602 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015605 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15606 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15607 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15608 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15609 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611src_port : integer
15612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15613 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15614 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15615 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015618 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015619 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15620 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15621 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015622 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15625 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15626 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15627 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15628 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015629 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15632 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15633 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15634 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15635 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15636 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15637 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15638 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15639 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015640
15641 Example :
15642 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15643 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15644 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15645 listen ssh
15646 bind :22
15647 mode tcp
15648 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015649 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015651 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653srv_id : integer
15654 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15655 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15656 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156587.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15662closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15663when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15664usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015665future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015666
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001566751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15668 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15669 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15670 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15671 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15672 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15673
15674 Example :
15675 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15676 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15677 # the request.
15678 frontend http-in
15679 bind *:8081
15680 default_backend servers
15681 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15682 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15683
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015684ssl_bc : boolean
15685 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15686 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15687 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15688
15689ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15690 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15691 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15692
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015693ssl_bc_alpn : string
15694 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15695 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015696 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015697 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15698 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15699 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15700 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15701 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15702 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15703
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015704ssl_bc_cipher : string
15705 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15706 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15707
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015708ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15709 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15710 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15711 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15712
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015713ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15714 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15715 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15716 session or a TLS ticket.
15717
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015718ssl_bc_npn : string
15719 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15720 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015721 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015722 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15723 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15724 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15725 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15726 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15727
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015728ssl_bc_protocol : string
15729 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15730 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15731
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015732ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015733 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015734 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15735 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015736
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015737ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15738 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15739 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15740 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15741
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015742ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15743 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15744 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15745 if session was reused or not.
15746
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015747ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15748 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15749 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15750 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15751 BoringSSL.
15752
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015753ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15754 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15755 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15758 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15759 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15760 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15761 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15762 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15765 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15766 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15767 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15768 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015769
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015770ssl_c_der : binary
15771 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15772 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15773 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775ssl_c_err : integer
15776 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15777 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15778 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15779 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15780 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15783 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15784 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15785 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15786 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15787 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15788 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15789 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15790 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792ssl_c_key_alg : string
15793 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15794 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15795 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797ssl_c_notafter : string
15798 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15799 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15800 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802ssl_c_notbefore : string
15803 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15804 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15805 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15808 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15809 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15810 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15811 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15812 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15813 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15814 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15815 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817ssl_c_serial : binary
15818 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15819 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15820 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15823 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15824 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15825 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015826 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15827 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15828
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015829 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015830 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015832ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15833 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15834 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15835 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837ssl_c_used : boolean
15838 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15839 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841ssl_c_verify : integer
15842 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15843 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15844 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15845 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847ssl_c_version : integer
15848 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15849 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015850
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015851ssl_f_der : binary
15852 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15853 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15854 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15857 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15858 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15859 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15860 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015861 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15863 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15864 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866ssl_f_key_alg : string
15867 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15868 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15869 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871ssl_f_notafter : string
15872 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15873 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15874 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_f_notbefore : string
15877 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15878 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15879 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15883 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15884 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15885 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15886 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15887 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15888 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15889 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891ssl_f_serial : binary
15892 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15893 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15894 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015895
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015896ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15897 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15898 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15899 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15902 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15903 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15904 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906ssl_f_version : integer
15907 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15908 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15909
15910ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015911 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15912 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15913 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915 Example :
15916 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15917 listen http-https
15918 bind :80
15919 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15920 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15921
15922ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15923 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15924 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15925
15926ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015927 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15929 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15930 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15931 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15932 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15933 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15934 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15935 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937ssl_fc_cipher : string
15938 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15939 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015940
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015941ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15942 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15943 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015944 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015945
15946ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15947 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15948 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015949 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015950
15951ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15952 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15953 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15954 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015955 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015956 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015957
15958ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15959 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15960 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015961 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015962
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015963ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15964 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15965 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15966 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015969 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15970 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015971 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15972 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15973 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15974 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015975
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015976ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15977 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15978 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15979 wait until the handshake happened.
15980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15982 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015983 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15984 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015985 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015986 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015987
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015988ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015989 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015990 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15991 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015994 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15996 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15997 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15998 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15999 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16000 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16001 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003ssl_fc_protocol : string
16004 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16005 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016006
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016007ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016008 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016009 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16010 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016011
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016012ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16013 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16014 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16015 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16018 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16019 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16020 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16021 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016022
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016023ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16024 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16025 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16026 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16027 BoringSSL.
16028
16029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030ssl_fc_sni : string
16031 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16032 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16033 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16034 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16035 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16036
16037 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16038 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16039 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016040 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016041 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16045 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16048 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16049 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016050
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160527.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16056sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16057only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16058For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16059be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16060can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16061sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16062for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16063content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16068 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16071 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016072 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016074
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016075req.hdrs : string
16076 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16077 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16078 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16079 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16080
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016081req.hdrs_bin : binary
16082 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16083 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16084 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16085 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16086 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16087 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16088
16089 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16090
16091 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16092 str: <int:length><bytes>
16093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094req.len : integer
16095req_len : integer (deprecated)
16096 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16097 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16098 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16099 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16100 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16101 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16102 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16103 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16106 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016107 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16108 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16109 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16110 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 ACL alternatives :
16113 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16116 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16117 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16118 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16119 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121 ACL alternatives :
16122 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126req.proto_http : boolean
16127req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16128 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16129 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16130 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16131 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16132 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16133 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16134 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 Example:
16137 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16138 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16139 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016140 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16143rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16144 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16145 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16146 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16147 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16148 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16149 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16150 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16153 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16154 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16155 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16156 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16157 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 ACL derivatives :
16160 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162 Example :
16163 listen tse-farm
16164 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16165 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16166 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16167 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16168 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16169 persist rdp-cookie
16170 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16171 # This is only useful makes sense if
16172 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16173 stick-table type string size 204800
16174 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16175 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16176 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16179 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16182rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16183 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16184 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16185 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16186 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188 ACL derivatives :
16189 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016190
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016191req.ssl_alpn : string
16192 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16193 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16194 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16195 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16196 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16197 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016198 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016199
16200 Examples :
16201 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16202 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16203 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016204 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016205 default_backend bk_default
16206
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016207req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16208 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16209 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016210 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16211 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16212 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16213 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16214 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16217req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16218 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16219 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16220 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16221 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16222 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16223 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16224 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226req.ssl_sni : string
16227req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16228 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16229 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16230 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16231 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16232 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16233 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16234 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16235 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16236 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16237 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16238 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16239 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241 ACL derivatives :
16242 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 Examples :
16245 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16246 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16247 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16248 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16249 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016250
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016251req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16252 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16253 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16254 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16255 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16256 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16257 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16258 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16259 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16260 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262req.ssl_ver : integer
16263req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16264 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16265 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16266 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16267 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16268 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16269 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16270 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016271 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274 ACL derivatives :
16275 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016276
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016277res.len : integer
16278 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16279 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16280 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16281 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16282 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16283 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16284 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16285 content inspection.
16286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16288 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016289 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16290 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16291 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16292 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16295 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16296 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16297 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16298 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016301
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016302res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16303rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16304 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16305 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16306 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16307 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16308 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16309 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16310 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312wait_end : boolean
16313 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16314 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016315 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16317 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016318 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16320 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322 Examples :
16323 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16324 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16325 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16328 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16329 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16330 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16331 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16332 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16333 tcp-request content reject
16334
16335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163367.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337--------------------------------------
16338
16339It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16340This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16341data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16342its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16343HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16344content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16345to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16346more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16347response are indexed.
16348
16349base : string
16350 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16351 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16352 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16353 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16354 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16355 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16356 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16357 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16358
16359 ACL derivatives :
16360 base : exact string match
16361 base_beg : prefix match
16362 base_dir : subdir match
16363 base_dom : domain match
16364 base_end : suffix match
16365 base_len : length match
16366 base_reg : regex match
16367 base_sub : substring match
16368
16369base32 : integer
16370 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16371 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16372 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016373 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16374 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16375 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376
16377base32+src : binary
16378 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16379 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16380 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16381 per-URL counters.
16382
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016383capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16384 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16385 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16386 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16387
16388capture.req.method : string
16389 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16390 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16391 because it's allocated.
16392
16393capture.req.uri : string
16394 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16395 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16396 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16397 allocated.
16398
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016399capture.req.ver : string
16400 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16401 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16402 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16403
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016404capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16405 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16406 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16407 The first entry is an index of 0.
16408 See also: "capture response header"
16409
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016410capture.res.ver : string
16411 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16412 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16413 persistent flag.
16414
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016415req.body : binary
16416 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16417 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16418 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16419 the first chunk is analyzed.
16420
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016421req.body_param([<name>) : string
16422 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16423 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16424 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16425 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16426 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16427 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16428 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16429 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16430 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16431 given.
16432
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016433req.body_len : integer
16434 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16435 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16436 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16437 "option http-buffer-request".
16438
16439req.body_size : integer
16440 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16441 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16442 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16443 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16444 "option http-buffer-request".
16445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016446req.cook([<name>]) : string
16447cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16448 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16449 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16450 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16451 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16452 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16453 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16454 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16455 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16456
16457 ACL derivatives :
16458 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16459 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16460 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16461 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16462 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16463 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16464 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16465 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16468cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16469 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16470 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16473cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16474 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16475 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16476 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16477 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16480 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16481 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16482 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16483 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016484 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016485 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16486 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16487 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16488 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16491 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16492 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16493 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16494 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016495 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016497req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16498 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16499 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16500 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16501 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16502 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16503 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16504 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16505 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16508 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16509 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16510 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16511 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016513req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16515 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16516 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16517 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16518 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16519 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16520 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16521 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016522 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016524 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526 ACL derivatives :
16527 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16528 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16529 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16530 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16531 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16532 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16533 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16534 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16535
16536req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16537hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16538 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16539 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16540 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16541 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16542 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16543 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16544 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16545 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16546 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16547
16548req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16549hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16550 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16551 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16552 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16553 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16554 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016555 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016556 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16557 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16558
16559req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16560hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16561 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16562 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16563 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16564 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16565 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16566 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16567 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16568
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016569
16570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016571http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16572 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16573 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16574 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16575 basic auth is supported.
16576
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016577http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16578 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16579 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16580 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16581 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16583 basic auth is supported.
16584
16585 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016586 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16587 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16588 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16589 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590
16591http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016592 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16593 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16595 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597method : integer + string
16598 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16599 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16600 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16601 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16602 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16603 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16604 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 ACL derivatives :
16607 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609 Example :
16610 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16611 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16612 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614path : string
16615 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16616 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16617 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16618 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16619 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016620 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016621 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623 ACL derivatives :
16624 path : exact string match
16625 path_beg : prefix match
16626 path_dir : subdir match
16627 path_dom : domain match
16628 path_end : suffix match
16629 path_len : length match
16630 path_reg : regex match
16631 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016632
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016633query : string
16634 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16635 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16636 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16637 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016638 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016639 which stops before the question mark.
16640
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016641req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16642 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16643 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16644 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16645 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647req.ver : string
16648req_ver : string (deprecated)
16649 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16650 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16651 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653 ACL derivatives :
16654 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656res.comp : boolean
16657 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16658 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16659 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661res.comp_algo : string
16662 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16663 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16664 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666res.cook([<name>]) : string
16667scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16668 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16669 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16670 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672 ACL derivatives :
16673 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16676scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16677 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16678 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16679 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16682scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16683 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16684 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16685 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016687res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16688 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16689 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16690 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16691 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16692 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16693 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16694 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16695 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16696 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16699 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16700 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16701 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16702 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16703 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016705res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16706shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16707 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16708 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16709 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16710 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16711 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16712 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16713 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16714 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716 ACL derivatives :
16717 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16718 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16719 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16720 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16721 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16722 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16723 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16724 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16725
16726res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16727shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16728 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16729 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16730 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16731 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16732 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16735shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16736 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16737 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16738 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16739 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16740 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16741 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016742
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016743res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16744 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16745 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16746 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16747 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016749res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16750shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16751 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16752 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16753 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16754 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16755 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16756 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758res.ver : string
16759resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16760 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16761 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763 ACL derivatives :
16764 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16767 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16768 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016769 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16773 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775status : integer
16776 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16777 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16778 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016779
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016780unique-id : string
16781 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16782 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16783 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16784 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16785 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16786 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788url : string
16789 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16790 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16791 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16792 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16793 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16794 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16795 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797 ACL derivatives :
16798 url : exact string match
16799 url_beg : prefix match
16800 url_dir : subdir match
16801 url_dom : domain match
16802 url_end : suffix match
16803 url_len : length match
16804 url_reg : regex match
16805 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807url_ip : ip
16808 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16809 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16810 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16811 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16812 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16813 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16814 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816url_port : integer
16817 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16818 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16819 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16820 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016821
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016822urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16823url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16825 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016826 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16827 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16828 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16829 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16831 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016832 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16833 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835 ACL derivatives :
16836 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16837 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16838 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16839 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16840 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16841 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16842 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16843 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016844
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846 Example :
16847 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16848 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16849 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16850 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016851
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016852urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016853 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16854 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16855 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016856
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016857url32 : integer
16858 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16859 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16860 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16861 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16862 is an unsigned integer.
16863
16864url32+src : binary
16865 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16866 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16867 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16868
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168707.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016871---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016873Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16874every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016875order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016877ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16878---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016879FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016880HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016881HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16882HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016883HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16884HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16885HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16886HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16887LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016888METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016889METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016890METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16891METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16892METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16893METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016894METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016895METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016896RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016897REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016898TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016899WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16900---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169038. Logging
16904----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016905
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16907provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16908very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16909provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16910state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016911to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016912headers.
16913
16914In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16915about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16916send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16917
16918 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16919 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16920 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16921 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16922 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016923 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016924 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
16926The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16927allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16928as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16929while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16930real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16931delay.
16932
16933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169348.1. Log levels
16935---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016936
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016937TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016939HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16940in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16941track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16942syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16943about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016944
16945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169468.2. Log formats
16947----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016948
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016949HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016950and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16951slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16952options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016953
16954 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16955 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16956 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16957 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16958 extents.
16959
16960 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16961 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16962 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16963 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16964 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16965
16966 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16967 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16968 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16969 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16970 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16971
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016972 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16973 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16974 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16975 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16976
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016977 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16978
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016979Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16980specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16981field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16982servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16983always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16984identifier.
16985
16986Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16987 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16988 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16989 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16990 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16991
16992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169938.2.1. Default log format
16994-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995
16996This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16997as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16998format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16999
17000 Example :
17001 listen www
17002 mode http
17003 log global
17004 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17005
17006 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17007 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17008 (www/HTTP)
17009
17010 Field Format Extract from the example above
17011 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17012 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17013 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17014 4 'to' to
17015 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17016 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17017
17018Detailed fields description :
17019 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17020 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17021 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17022 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17023 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17024 and processed the connection.
17025 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17026
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017027In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17028"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17029connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017031It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17032will eventually disappear.
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.2.2. TCP log format
17036---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
17038The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17039is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17040information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17041counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17042emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17043environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17044the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17045sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017046specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17047not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17048fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17049marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050
17051 Example :
17052 frontend fnt
17053 mode tcp
17054 option tcplog
17055 log global
17056 default_backend bck
17057
17058 backend bck
17059 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17060
17061 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17062 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17063 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17064
17065 Field Format Extract from the example above
17066 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17067 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17068 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17069 4 frontend_name fnt
17070 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17071 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17072 7 bytes_read* 212
17073 8 termination_state --
17074 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17075 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17076
17077Detailed fields description :
17078 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017079 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17080 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17081 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017082 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017083 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017084 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017085
17086 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017087 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17088 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17089 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090
17091 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17092 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17093 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017094 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17095 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17096 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17097 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017098
17099 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17100 and processed the connection.
17101
17102 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17103 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17104 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17105 applications.
17106
17107 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17108 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17109 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17110 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17111 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17112
17113 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17114 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17115 See "Timers" below for more details.
17116
17117 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17118 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17119 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17120 "Timers" below for more details.
17121
17122 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017123 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17125 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17126 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17127 details.
17128
17129 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17130 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17131 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17132 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17133 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17134
17135 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17136 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17137 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17138 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17139 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17140 for more details.
17141
17142 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017143 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17145 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17146 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017147 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148
17149 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17150 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17151 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17152 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17153 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17154 caused by a denial of service attack.
17155
17156 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17157 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17158 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17159 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17160 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17161 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17162 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17163 denial of service attack.
17164
17165 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17166 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17167 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17168 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17169 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17170 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17171 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17172 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17173 be processed than on other servers.
17174
17175 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17176 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17177 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17178 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17179 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17180 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17181 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17182 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17183 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17184 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17185 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17186 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17187 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17188
17189 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17190 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17191 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17192 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17193 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17194 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017195 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017196 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17197
17198 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17199 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17200 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17201 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17202 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17203 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017205 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17206 occurs.
17207
17208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172098.2.3. HTTP log format
17210----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017211
17212The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17213is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17214the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17215are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17216emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17217generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17218"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17219which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017220frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17221is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222
17223Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17224slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17225with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17226
17227 Example :
17228 frontend http-in
17229 mode http
17230 option httplog
17231 log global
17232 default_backend bck
17233
17234 backend static
17235 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17236
17237 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17238 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17239 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017240 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017241
17242 Field Format Extract from the example above
17243 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17244 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017245 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017246 4 frontend_name http-in
17247 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017248 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249 7 status_code 200
17250 8 bytes_read* 2750
17251 9 captured_request_cookie -
17252 10 captured_response_cookie -
17253 11 termination_state ----
17254 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17255 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17256 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17257 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17258 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017259
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260Detailed fields description :
17261 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017262 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17263 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17264 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017265 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017266 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017267 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268
17269 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017270 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17271 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17272 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017274 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17275 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017276
17277 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17278 and processed the connection.
17279
17280 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17281 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17282 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17283
17284 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17285 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17286 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17287 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17288 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17289 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17290
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017291 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17292 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17293 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017294 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017295 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17296 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017297 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17298 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299
17300 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17301 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017302 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017303
17304 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17305 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017306 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17307 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17310 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17311 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17312 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17313 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017314 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17315 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017317 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17318 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17319 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17320 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17321 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17322 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17323 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017324 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325
17326 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17327 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17328 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17329
17330 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17331 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017332 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017333 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17334 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17335 overflowing.
17336
17337 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17338 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17339 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17340 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17341 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17342 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17343 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17344 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17345
17346 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17347 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17348 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17349 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17350 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17351 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17352 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17353 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17354
17355 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17356 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17357 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17358 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17359 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17360 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17361 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17362
17363 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017364 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017365 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17366 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17367 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017368 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017369 system.
17370
17371 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17372 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17373 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17374 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17375 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17376 caused by a denial of service attack.
17377
17378 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17379 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17380 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17381 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17382 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17383 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17384 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17385 denial of service attack.
17386
17387 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17388 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17389 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17390 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17391 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17392 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17393 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17394 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17395 processed than on other servers.
17396
17397 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17398 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17399 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17400 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17401 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17402 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17403 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17404 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17405 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17406 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17407 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17408 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17409 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17410
17411 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17412 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17413 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17414 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17415 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17416 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017417 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017418 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17419
17420 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17421 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17422 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17423 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17424 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17425 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017426 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017427 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17428 occurs.
17429
17430 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17431 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17432 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17433 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17434 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17435 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17436 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17437 cookies" below for more details.
17438
17439 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17440 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17441 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17442 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17443 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17444 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17445 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17446 and cookies" below for more details.
17447
17448 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17449 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17450 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17451 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17452 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17453 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17454 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17455 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17456
17457
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200174588.2.4. Custom log format
17459------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017460
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017461The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017462mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017464HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017465Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17466separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17467prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17468
17469Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17470variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017471("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017472
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017473If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017474as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017475less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17476the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17477
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017478Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017479In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017480in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017481
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017482Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17483'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17484https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17485such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17486
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017487Flags are :
17488 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017489 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017490 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17491 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017492
17493 Example:
17494
17495 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17496 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17497
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017498 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17499
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017500At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017502 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17503 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017504
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017505the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017506
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017507 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17508 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17509 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017510
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017511and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17512
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017513 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17514 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017515
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017516Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17517
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017518 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017519 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017520 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17521 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17522 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017523 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17524 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17525 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017526 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017527 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17528 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017529 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017530 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17531 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017532 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017533 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017534 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017535 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017536 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017537 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017538 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017539 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17540 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17541 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17542 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17543 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017544 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017545 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17546 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017547 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017548 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17549 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017550 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17551 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17552 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017553 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017554 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17555 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017556 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017557 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17558 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17559 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017560 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017561 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017562 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17563 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17564 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17565 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017566 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017567 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017568 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017569 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017570 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017571 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017572 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17573 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17574 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017575 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017576 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17577 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017578 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017579 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17580 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017581 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017582 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017583 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017584 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017585
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017586 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017587
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017588
175898.2.5. Error log format
17590-----------------------
17591
17592When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17593protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17594By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17595"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017596will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017597logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17598
17599The format looks like this :
17600
17601 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17602 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17603 Connection error during SSL handshake
17604
17605 Field Format Extract from the example above
17606 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17607 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17608 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17609 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17610 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17611
17612These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17613failures.
17614
17615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176168.3. Advanced logging options
17617-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017618
17619Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17620just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17621options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17622for more information about their usage.
17623
17624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17626------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017627
17628It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17629haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17630commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17631monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17632ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17633
17634 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17635 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17636 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17637 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17638
17639 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17640 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17641 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017642 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643 such as other load-balancers.
17644
17645 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17646 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17647 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17648
17649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17651----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017652
17653The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17654what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17655or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017656"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17658log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17659after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17660is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17661with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17662with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17663
17664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17666------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017667
17668Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17669for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17670"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17671retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17672raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17673a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17674file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17675you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17676"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17677
17678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17680--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017681
17682Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17683multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17684them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17685"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17686logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17687error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17688and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17689too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17690useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17691alternative.
17692
17693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176948.4. Timing events
17695------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696
17697Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17698reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17699the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17700frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017701mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17702addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17703
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017704Timings events in HTTP mode:
17705
17706 first request 2nd request
17707 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17708 t tr t tr ...
17709 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17710 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17711 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17712 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17713 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17714
17715Timings events in TCP mode:
17716
17717 TCP session
17718 |<----------------->|
17719 t t
17720 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17721 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17722 |<------ Tt ------->|
17723
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017724 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017726 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17727 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17728 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017730 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17731 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17732 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17733 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017735 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17736 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17737 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017738 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17739 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17740 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17741 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17742 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17743 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017744
17745 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17746 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17747 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17748 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17749 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17750 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17751 request typed by hand during a test.
17752
17753 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17754 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017755 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017756 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17757 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17758 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17759 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760
17761 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17762 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17763 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17764 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17765 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17766
17767 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17768 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17769 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17770 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17771 connection never established.
17772
17773 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17774 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17775 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17776 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17777 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17778 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17779 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17780 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17781 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17782 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17783 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17784
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017785 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17786 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17787 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17788 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17789 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17790 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17791
17792 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17793
17794 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17795 "Ta" can never be negative.
17796
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17798 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017799 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17800 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017801 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017803 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017804
17805 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017806 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17807 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808
17809These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17810protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17811that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017812due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17813"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17814that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017815
17816Most common cases :
17817
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017818 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17819 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17820 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17821 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17822 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17823 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17824 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17825 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17826 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17827 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17828 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017829 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017830
17831 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17832 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17833 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17834 of ms on remote networks.
17835
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017836 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17837 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17838 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017839
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017840 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17841 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17842 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17843 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17844 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17845 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17846 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17847 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17848 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017849
17850Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17851
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017852 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017853 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017854 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017856 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017857 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17858 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17859
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017860 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17862 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17863 flags.
17864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017865 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17866 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017867 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17868 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17869 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17870 the client connection was maintained open.
17871
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017872 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017873 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017874 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017875 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17876
17877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178788.5. Session state at disconnection
17879-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017880
17881TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17882"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
178832-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17884each of which has a special meaning :
17885
17886 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17887 session to terminate :
17888
17889 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17890
17891 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17892 server explicitly refused it.
17893
17894 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17895 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17896 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17897 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017898 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017899
17900 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17901 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017902
17903 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17904 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17905 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17906 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17907 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17908
17909 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17910 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17911 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17912 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17913 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17914
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017915 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17916 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17917
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017918 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17919 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17920 backup connections when going up.
17921
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017922 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17925 send or receive data.
17926
17927 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17928 send or receive data.
17929
17930 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17931 with nothing left in the buffers.
17932
17933 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17934
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017935 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017936 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17937
17938 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17939 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17940 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17941 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17942 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17943
17944 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17945 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17946
17947 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17948 server (HTTP only).
17949
17950 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17951
17952 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17953 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17954 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17955
17956 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17957 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17958 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17959
17960 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17961
17962 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17963 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17964
17965 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17966 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17967 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17968
17969 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17970 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017971 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17972 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017973
17974 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17975 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17976 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17977 another server.
17978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017979 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017980 server.
17981
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017982 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17983 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17984 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17985 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17986
17987 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17988 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17989 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17990 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17991
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017992 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17993 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17994 "use-server" rule).
17995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17997
17998 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17999 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18000
18001 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18002
18003 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18004 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18005 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18006
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018007 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18008 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018009 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018010 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18011 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018013 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18014
18015 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18016 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18017
18018 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18019
18020 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18021
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018022The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18023was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018024helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18025starvation, attacks, etc...
18026
18027The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18028alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18029easier finding and understanding.
18030
18031 Flags Reason
18032
18033 -- Normal termination.
18034
18035 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18036 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18037 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18038 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18039
18040 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18041 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18042 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18043 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18044 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18045 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018047 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18048 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018049 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018050
18051 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18052 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18053 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18054
18055 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18056 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18057 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18058 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18059 the server takes too long to respond.
18060
18061 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18062 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18063 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18064 long a time to respond.
18065
18066 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18067 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18068 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18069 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018070 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18071 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018072
18073 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18074 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18075 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18076 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18077 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018078 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018079 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18080 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18081 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18082 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18083 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18084 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18085 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18086 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018088 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18089 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18090 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018091
18092 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18093 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018094 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18095 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18096 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18097 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018098
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018099 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18100 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018102 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18104 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018105 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18107 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18108
18109 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18110 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18111 503 or 504 here.
18112
18113 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18114 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18115 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18116 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18117 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18118
18119 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18120 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018121 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018122 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18123 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18124
18125 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18126 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18127 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18128 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18129 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18130 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18131 between haproxy and the server.
18132
18133 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18134 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18135 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18136 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18137 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18138 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18139 solution is to fix the application.
18140
18141 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18142 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18143 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18144 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18145 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18146 external attacks.
18147
18148 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18149 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018150 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18152 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18153
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018154 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18155 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18156 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018157 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018158 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018160 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18161 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18162 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18163 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018164 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18165 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18166 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18167 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18168 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018169
18170 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18171 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18172 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18173 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18174
18175 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18176 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18177 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18178 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18179
18180 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18181 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18182 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18183 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18184
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018185The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18186persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18187important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18188re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18189
18190 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18191
18192 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18193 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18194 set on a GET request.
18195
18196 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18197 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018198 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018199 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18200
18201 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18202 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18203 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18204
18205 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18206 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18207 already got a cookie.
18208
18209 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18210 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18211 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18212 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18213 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18214
18215 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18216 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18217 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18218
18219 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18220 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18221 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18222
18223 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18224 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18225
18226 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18227 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18228 then advertised in the response.
18229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182318.6. Non-printable characters
18232-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018233
18234In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18235consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18236converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18237prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18238being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18239escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18240is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18241'}' when logging headers.
18242
18243Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18244issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18245containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18246
18247Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18248the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18249performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18250
18251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182528.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18253---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018254
18255Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18256achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018257section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018258cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18259the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18260the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018261locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018262not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18263user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18264a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18265wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18266
18267 Examples :
18268 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18269 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18270
18271 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18272 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18273
18274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182758.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18276---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018277
18278Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18279proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18280the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18281server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18282
18283Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18284response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018285section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018286
18287It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018288time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18289appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018290are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18291and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18292follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18293request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18294in the logs.
18295
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018296As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18297frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18298an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018300 Example :
18301 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18302 listen proxy-out
18303 mode http
18304 option httplog
18305 option logasap
18306 log global
18307 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18308
18309 # log the name of the virtual server
18310 capture request header Host len 20
18311
18312 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18313 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18314
18315 # log the beginning of the referrer
18316 capture request header Referer len 20
18317
18318 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18319 capture response header Server len 20
18320
18321 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18322 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18323
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018324 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018325 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18326
18327 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18328 capture response header Via len 20
18329
18330 # log the URL location during a redirection
18331 capture response header Location len 20
18332
18333 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18334 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18335 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18336 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18337 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18338
18339 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18340 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18341 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18342 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018343 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018344
18345 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18346 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18347 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18348 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18349 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018350 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018351
18352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183538.9. Examples of logs
18354---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018355
18356These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18357them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18358reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18359
18360 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18361 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18362 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18363
18364 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18365 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18366
18367 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18368 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18369 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18370
18371 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18372 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18373
18374 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18375 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18376 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18377
18378 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018379 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018380 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18381 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18382
18383 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18384 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18385 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18386
18387 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18388 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018389 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018390 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18391 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18392 to return the 502 and not the server.
18393
18394 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018395 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018396
18397 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18398 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18399 Nothing was sent to any server.
18400
18401 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18402 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18403
18404 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18405 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018406 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407 send a 408 return code to the client.
18408
18409 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18410 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18411
18412 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18413 5 seconds ("c----").
18414
18415 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18416 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018417 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018418
18419 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018420 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018421 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18422 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18423 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18424 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18425 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018426
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018427
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184289. Supported filters
18429--------------------
18430
18431Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18432accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18433unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18434
18435See also : "filter"
18436
184379.1. Trace
18438----------
18439
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018440filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018441
18442 Arguments:
18443 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18444 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18445
18446 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18447 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18448 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18449 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18450
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018451 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018452 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18453 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18454 amount of the parsed data.
18455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018456 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018457
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018458This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18459callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18460information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18461filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18462
18463Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18464tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18465a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18466
18467
184689.2. HTTP compression
18469---------------------
18470
18471filter compression
18472
18473The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18474keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018475when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18476it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18477response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18478line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18479cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18480the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018481
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018482See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018483
18484
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200184859.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18486--------------------------------------------
18487
18488filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18489
18490 Arguments :
18491
18492 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18493 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18494 parsed.
18495
18496 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18497 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18498 part must be placed in its own scope.
18499
18500The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18501external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018502streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018503exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18504also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18505
18506SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18507the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18508
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018509For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018510"doc/SPOE.txt".
18511
18512Important note:
18513 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18514 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18515
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185169.4. Cache
18517----------
18518
18519filter cache <name>
18520
18521 Arguments :
18522
18523 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18524
18525The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18526"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018527cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018528other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18529the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18530mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18531filter other than the compression is used for the same
18532listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18533order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018534
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018535See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018536
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001853710. Cache
18538---------
18539
18540HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18541(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18542RAM.
18543
18544The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018545this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018546
18547If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18548independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18549when we try to allocate a new one.
18550
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018551The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018552
18553It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18554"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18555for more details.
18556
18557When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18558replaced by "<CACHE>".
18559
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001856010.1. Limitation
18561----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018562
18563The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18564
18565- If the response is not a 200
18566- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018567- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018568- If the response is not cacheable
18569
18570- If the request is not a GET
18571- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018572- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018573
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018574Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18575filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18576can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18577example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18578"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018579
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001858010.2. Setup
18581-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018582
18583To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18584the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18585
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001858610.2.1. Cache section
18587---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018588
18589cache <name>
18590 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18591 size of cache is mandatory.
18592
18593total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018594 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018595 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018596
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018597max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018598 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18599 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18600 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018601
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018602max-age <seconds>
18603 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18604 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18605 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18606 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18607 default.
18608
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001860910.2.2. Proxy section
18610---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018611
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018612http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018613 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18614 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18615 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18616 after this one.
18617
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018618http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018619 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18620 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18621 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18622 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18623
18624
18625Example:
18626
18627 backend bck1
18628 mode http
18629
18630 http-request cache-use foobar
18631 http-response cache-store foobar
18632 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18633
18634 cache foobar
18635 total-max-size 4
18636 max-age 240
18637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018638/*
18639 * Local variables:
18640 * fill-column: 79
18641 * End:
18642 */